Automatic date update in version.in
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 typedef enum split16_format_type
41 {
42 split16a_type = 0,
43 split16d_type
44 }
45 split16_format_type;
46
47 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53
54 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60
61 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 section. */
63 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64
65 /* For old-style PLT. */
66 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68
69 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 ((4*4 \
73 + (h != NULL \
74 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78
79 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80
81 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 {
86 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 };
95 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 {
98 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 };
107
108 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 {
113 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 };
122 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 {
125 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 };
134
135 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137
138 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 a shared library. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145
146 /* Some instructions. */
147 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 #define B 0x48000000
155 #define BA 0x48000002
156 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 #define NOP 0x60000000
177 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178
179 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182
183 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 \f
189 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
190 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
191 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
192 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
193 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
194 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
195 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
196 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
197 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
198 complain, special_func) \
199 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
200 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
201 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
202
203 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
204
205 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
206 /* This reloc does nothing. */
207 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
208 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
209
210 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
211 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213
214 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
215 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
216 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
217 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
218
219 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
220 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
221 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222
223 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
224 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
225 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226
227 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
228 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
229 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230
231 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
232 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
233 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
234 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
235
236 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
237 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
238 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
239 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
240
241 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
242 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
243 bits must be zero. */
244 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
245 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
246
247 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
248 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
249 two bits must be zero. */
250 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
252
253 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
254 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
255 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256
257 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260
261 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
262 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
263 zero. */
264 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
265 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
266
267 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
268 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
269 be zero. */
270 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
271 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
272
273 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
274 symbol. */
275 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
276 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
277
278 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
279 the symbol. */
280 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
281 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
282
283 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
284 the symbol. */
285 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
286 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
287
288 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
289 the symbol. */
290 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
291 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
292
293 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
294 entry for the symbol. */
295 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
296 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
297
298 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
299 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
300 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
301 shared library into the object, because the object being
302 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
303 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
304 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
305
306 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
307 entries. */
308 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
309 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
310
311 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
312 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314
315 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
316 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
317 addend. */
318 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
322 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
323 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
324 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
328 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
332 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* 32-bit PC relative */
336 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
337 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338
339 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
340 FIXME: not supported. */
341 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
342 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
343
344 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
345 FIXME: not supported. */
346 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
347 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
348
349 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
350 the symbol. */
351 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
352 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
353
354 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
355 the symbol. */
356 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
357 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
358
359 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
360 the symbol. */
361 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
362 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
363
364 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
365 small data items. */
366 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
367 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
368
369 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
370 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372
373 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
374 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
375 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376
377 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
378 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
379 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380
381 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
382 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
386 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
387 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
388
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
396 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
403 definition of its TLS sym. */
404 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
405 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
406
407 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
408 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
409 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
410 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
414 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
415 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416
417 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
418 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
422 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
423 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424
425 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
426 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428
429 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
430 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
431 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
432 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
433
434 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
435 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
436 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437
438 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
439 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
440 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
443 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
444 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
447 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
451 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
452 to the first entry. */
453 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
457 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
458 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
461 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
462 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463
464 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
465 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
469 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
470 first entry. */
471 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
472 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
473
474 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
475 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
476 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477
478 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
479 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
480 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481
482 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
483 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485
486 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
487 the offset to the entry. */
488 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
489 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
490
491 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
492 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494
495 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
496 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
497 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498
499 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
500 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502
503 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
504 offset to the entry. */
505 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
506 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
507
508 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
509 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
510 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511
512 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
513 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
517 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519
520 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
521 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
522
523 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
524 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
525 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
529 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530
531 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
533 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534
535 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
536 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
537 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538
539 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
540 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
541 is negative. */
542 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
543 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
546 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
547 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
548 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
549 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
550
551 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
552 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
553 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
554 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
555 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
556
557 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
558 small data items. */
559 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
560 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
563 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
564 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
565 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
569 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
570 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
574
575 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
576 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
577 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
578 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
579 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
580
581 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
582 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
583 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
584
585 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
586 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
587 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588
589 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
590 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592
593 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
594 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
595 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
596
597 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
598 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600
601 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
602 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
603 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604
605 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
606 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608
609 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
610 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612
613 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
614 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616
617 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
618 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
619 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
620 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
621 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
622
623 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
624 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
625 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
628 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630
631 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
632 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634
635 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
636 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
637 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638
639 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
640 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642
643 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
644 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646
647 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
648 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* e_li split20 format. */
652 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
653 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654
655 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
659 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
660 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
661
662 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
664 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665
666 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
667 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
668 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669
670 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
671 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
672 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
673 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
674
675 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
676 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
677 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678
679 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
680 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
681 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682
683 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
684 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
685 NULL),
686
687 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
688 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 NULL),
690
691 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
692 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
693 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
694 };
695 \f
696 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
697
698 static void
699 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
700 {
701 unsigned int i, type;
702
703 for (i = 0;
704 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
705 i++)
706 {
707 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
708 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
709 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
710 abort ();
711 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
712 }
713 }
714
715 static reloc_howto_type *
716 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
717 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
718 {
719 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
720
721 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
722 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
723 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
724
725 switch (code)
726 {
727 default:
728 return NULL;
729
730 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
731 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
732 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
733 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
734 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
736 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
747 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
749 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
760 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
765 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
767 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
772 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
835 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
836 break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
854 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
860 }
861
862 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
863 };
864
865 static reloc_howto_type *
866 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
867 const char *r_name)
868 {
869 unsigned int i;
870
871 for (i = 0;
872 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
873 i++)
874 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
875 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
876 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
877
878 return NULL;
879 }
880
881 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
882
883 static bfd_boolean
884 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
885 arelent *cache_ptr,
886 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
887 {
888 unsigned int r_type;
889
890 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
891 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
892 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
893
894 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
895 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
896 {
897 /* xgettext:c-format */
898 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
899 abfd, r_type);
900 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
901 return FALSE;
902 }
903
904 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
905
906 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
907 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
908 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
909 {
910 /* xgettext:c-format */
911 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
912 abfd, r_type);
913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
914
915 return FALSE;
916 }
917
918 return TRUE;
919 }
920
921 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
922
923 static bfd_reloc_status_type
924 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
925 arelent *reloc_entry,
926 asymbol *symbol,
927 void *data,
928 asection *input_section,
929 bfd *output_bfd,
930 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
931 {
932 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
933 long insn;
934 bfd_size_type octets;
935 bfd_vma value;
936
937 if (output_bfd != NULL)
938 {
939 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
940 return bfd_reloc_ok;
941 }
942
943 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
944 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
945 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
946 return bfd_reloc_continue;
947
948 value = 0;
949 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
950 value = symbol->value;
951 value += (reloc_entry->addend
952 + symbol->section->output_offset
953 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
954 value -= (reloc_entry->address
955 + input_section->output_offset
956 + input_section->output_section->vma);
957 value >>= 16;
958
959 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
960 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
961 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
962 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
963 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 return bfd_reloc_ok;
965 }
966
967 static bfd_reloc_status_type
968 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
969 arelent *reloc_entry,
970 asymbol *symbol,
971 void *data,
972 asection *input_section,
973 bfd *output_bfd,
974 char **error_message)
975 {
976 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
977 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
978 link time. */
979 if (output_bfd != NULL)
980 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
981 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
982
983 if (error_message != NULL)
984 {
985 static char buf[60];
986 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
987 reloc_entry->howto->name);
988 *error_message = buf;
989 }
990 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
991 }
992 \f
993 /* Sections created by the linker. */
994
995 typedef struct elf_linker_section
996 {
997 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
998 asection *section;
999 /* Section name. */
1000 const char *name;
1001 /* Associated bss section name. */
1002 const char *bss_name;
1003 /* Associated symbol name. */
1004 const char *sym_name;
1005 /* Associated symbol. */
1006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1007 } elf_linker_section_t;
1008
1009 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1010 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1011 based on different addend's. */
1012
1013 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1014 {
1015 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1016 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1017 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1018 bfd_vma offset;
1019 /* addend used */
1020 bfd_vma addend;
1021 /* which linker section this is */
1022 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1023 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1024
1025 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1026 {
1027 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1028
1029 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1030 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1031 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1032
1033 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1034 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1035 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1036 };
1037
1038 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1039 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1040
1041 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1042 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1043
1044 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1045 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1046 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1047
1048 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1049
1050 static bfd_boolean
1051 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1054 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1058
1059 bfd_boolean
1060 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1061 {
1062 unsigned long mach = 0;
1063 asection *s;
1064 unsigned char *contents;
1065
1066 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1067 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1068 {
1069
1070 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1071 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1072 break;
1073 if (s != NULL)
1074 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1075 }
1076
1077 if (mach == 0)
1078 {
1079 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1080 if (s != NULL
1081 && s->size >= 24
1082 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1083 {
1084 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1085 unsigned int i;
1086
1087 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1088 {
1089 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1090 switch (val >> 16)
1091 {
1092 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1093 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1094 if (mach == 0)
1095 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1096 break;
1097
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1099 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1100 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1101 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1102 break;
1103
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1105 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1106 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1107 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1108 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1109 break;
1110
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1112 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1113 break;
1114
1115 default:
1116 mach = -1ul;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 free (contents);
1120 }
1121 }
1122
1123 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1124 {
1125 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1126
1127 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1128 if (arch->mach == mach)
1129 {
1130 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1131 break;
1132 }
1133 }
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1138 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1139
1140 static bfd_boolean
1141 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1142 {
1143 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1144 return TRUE;
1145
1146 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1147 {
1148 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1149
1150 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1151 {
1152 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1153 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1154 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1155 }
1156 }
1157 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1161
1162 static bfd_boolean
1163 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1164 {
1165 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1166 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1167
1168 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1169 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1170 return TRUE;
1171 }
1172
1173 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1174
1175 static bfd_boolean
1176 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1177 {
1178 int offset;
1179 unsigned int size;
1180
1181 switch (note->descsz)
1182 {
1183 default:
1184 return FALSE;
1185
1186 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1187 /* pr_cursig */
1188 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1189
1190 /* pr_pid */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1192
1193 /* pr_reg */
1194 offset = 72;
1195 size = 192;
1196
1197 break;
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1201 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1202 size, note->descpos + offset);
1203 }
1204
1205 static bfd_boolean
1206 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1207 {
1208 switch (note->descsz)
1209 {
1210 default:
1211 return FALSE;
1212
1213 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1214 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1215 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1216 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1217 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1218 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1219 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1223 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1224 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1225
1226 {
1227 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1228 int n = strlen (command);
1229
1230 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1231 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1232 }
1233
1234 return TRUE;
1235 }
1236
1237 static char *
1238 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1239 {
1240 switch (note_type)
1241 {
1242 default:
1243 return NULL;
1244
1245 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1246 {
1247 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1248 va_list ap;
1249
1250 va_start (ap, note_type);
1251 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1252 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1253 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1254 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1255 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1256 -Wstringop-truncation:
1257 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1258 */
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1260 #endif
1261 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1262 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1263 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1264 #endif
1265 va_end (ap);
1266 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1267 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1268 }
1269
1270 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1271 {
1272 char data[268];
1273 va_list ap;
1274 long pid;
1275 int cursig;
1276 const void *greg;
1277
1278 va_start (ap, note_type);
1279 memset (data, 0, 72);
1280 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1281 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1282 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1283 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1284 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1285 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1286 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1287 va_end (ap);
1288 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1289 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1290 }
1291 }
1292 }
1293
1294 static flagword
1295 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1296 {
1297
1298 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1299 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1300
1301 return 0;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1305 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1306
1307 static bfd_vma
1308 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 const arelent *rel)
1311 {
1312 return rel->address;
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1316 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1317 type. */
1318
1319 static bfd_boolean
1320 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1322 const char *name,
1323 int shindex)
1324 {
1325 asection *newsect;
1326 flagword flags;
1327
1328 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1329 return FALSE;
1330
1331 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1332 flags = bfd_get_section_flags (abfd, newsect);
1333 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1334 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1335
1336 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1337 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1338
1339 bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags);
1340 return TRUE;
1341 }
1342
1343 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1344
1345 static bfd_boolean
1346 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1348 asection *asect)
1349 {
1350 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1351 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1352
1353 return TRUE;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1357 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1358
1359 static int
1360 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1361 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1362 {
1363 asection *s;
1364 int ret = 0;
1365
1366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1367 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1368 ++ret;
1369
1370 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1371 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1372 ++ret;
1373
1374 return ret;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1378
1379 bfd_boolean
1380 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1381 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1382 {
1383 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1384
1385 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1386 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1387 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1388 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1389 We maintain the original output section order. */
1390
1391 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1392 {
1393 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1394 bfd_size_type amt;
1395 unsigned int j, k;
1396 unsigned int p_flags;
1397
1398 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1399 continue;
1400
1401 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1402 {
1403 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1404 p_flags |= PF_W;
1405 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1406 {
1407 p_flags |= PF_X;
1408 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1409 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1410 break;
1411 }
1412 }
1413 if (j != m->count)
1414 while (++j != m->count)
1415 {
1416 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1417
1418 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1419 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1420 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1421 {
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1423 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1424 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1425 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 break;
1427 }
1428 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1429 }
1430 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1431 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1432 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1433 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1434 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1435 {
1436 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1437 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1438 }
1439 if (j == m->count)
1440 continue;
1441
1442 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1443 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1444 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1445
1446 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1447 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1448 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1449 if (n == NULL)
1450 return FALSE;
1451
1452 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1453 n->count = m->count - j;
1454 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1455 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1456 m->count = j;
1457 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1458 n->next = m->next;
1459 m->next = n;
1460 }
1461
1462 return TRUE;
1463 }
1464
1465 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1466 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1467 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1468 2 sections. */
1469
1470 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1471 {
1472 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1473 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1474 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1482 };
1483
1484 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1485 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1487
1488 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1489 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1490 {
1491 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1492
1493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1494 if (sec->name == NULL)
1495 return NULL;
1496
1497 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1498 sec->use_rela_p);
1499 if (ssect != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1502 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1503 return ssect;
1504 }
1505
1506 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1507 }
1508 \f
1509 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1510 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1511 {
1512 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1513 unsigned long value;
1514 }
1515 apuinfo_list;
1516
1517 static apuinfo_list *head;
1518 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1519
1520 static void
1521 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1522 {
1523 head = NULL;
1524 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1525 }
1526
1527 static void
1528 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1529 {
1530 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1531
1532 while (entry != NULL)
1533 {
1534 if (entry->value == value)
1535 return;
1536 entry = entry->next;
1537 }
1538
1539 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1540 if (entry == NULL)
1541 return;
1542
1543 entry->value = value;
1544 entry->next = head;
1545 head = entry;
1546 }
1547
1548 static unsigned
1549 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1550 {
1551 apuinfo_list *entry;
1552 unsigned long count;
1553
1554 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1555 entry;
1556 entry = entry->next)
1557 ++ count;
1558
1559 return count;
1560 }
1561
1562 static inline unsigned long
1563 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1564 {
1565 apuinfo_list * entry;
1566
1567 for (entry = head;
1568 entry && number --;
1569 entry = entry->next)
1570 ;
1571
1572 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1573 }
1574
1575 static void
1576 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1577 {
1578 apuinfo_list *entry;
1579
1580 for (entry = head; entry;)
1581 {
1582 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1583 free (entry);
1584 entry = next;
1585 }
1586
1587 head = NULL;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1591 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1595 {
1596 bfd *ibfd;
1597 asection *asec;
1598 char *buffer = NULL;
1599 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1600 unsigned i;
1601 unsigned long length;
1602 const char *error_message = NULL;
1603
1604 if (link_info == NULL)
1605 return;
1606
1607 apuinfo_list_init ();
1608
1609 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1610 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long datum;
1613
1614 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1615 if (asec == NULL)
1616 continue;
1617
1618 /* xgettext:c-format */
1619 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1620 length = asec->size;
1621 if (length < 20)
1622 goto fail;
1623
1624 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1625 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1626 {
1627 if (buffer)
1628 free (buffer);
1629 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1630 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1631 if (!buffer)
1632 return;
1633 }
1634
1635 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1636 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1637 {
1638 /* xgettext:c-format */
1639 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1640 goto fail;
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1644 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1645 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1646 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1647 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1648 goto fail;
1649
1650 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1651 if (datum != 0x2)
1652 goto fail;
1653
1654 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1659 if (datum + 20 != length)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1663 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1664 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1665 }
1666
1667 error_message = NULL;
1668
1669 if (apuinfo_set)
1670 {
1671 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1672 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1673
1674 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1675 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1676
1677 if (asec && ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1678 {
1679 ibfd = abfd;
1680 /* xgettext:c-format */
1681 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 fail:
1686 if (buffer)
1687 free (buffer);
1688
1689 if (error_message)
1690 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1694 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1695
1696 static bfd_boolean
1697 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1698 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1699 asection *asec,
1700 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1701 {
1702 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1706
1707 static void
1708 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1709 {
1710 bfd_byte *buffer;
1711 asection *asec;
1712 unsigned i;
1713 unsigned num_entries;
1714 bfd_size_type length;
1715
1716 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1717 if (asec == NULL)
1718 return;
1719
1720 if (!apuinfo_set)
1721 return;
1722
1723 length = asec->size;
1724 if (length < 20)
1725 return;
1726
1727 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1728 if (buffer == NULL)
1729 {
1730 _bfd_error_handler
1731 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1732 return;
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1736 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1737 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1738 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1740 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1741
1742 length = 20;
1743 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1744 {
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1746 length += 4;
1747 }
1748
1749 if (length != asec->size)
1750 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1751
1752 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 free (buffer);
1756
1757 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1758 }
1759
1760 static bfd_boolean
1761 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1762 {
1763 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1764 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1765 }
1766 \f
1767 static bfd_boolean
1768 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1769 {
1770 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1771
1772 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1773 return FALSE;
1774
1775 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1776 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1777 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1778 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1779 }
1780
1781 static bfd_boolean
1782 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1783 {
1784 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1785 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1786 && section->vma <= vma
1787 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1788 }
1789
1790 static long
1791 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1792 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1793 asymbol **ret)
1794 {
1795 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1796 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1797 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1798 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1799 bfd_vma stub_off;
1800 asymbol *s;
1801 arelent *p;
1802 long count, i, stub_delta;
1803 size_t size;
1804 char *names;
1805 bfd_byte buf[4];
1806
1807 *ret = NULL;
1808
1809 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1810 return 0;
1811
1812 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1813 return 0;
1814
1815 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1816 if (relplt == NULL)
1817 return 0;
1818
1819 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1820 if (plt == NULL)
1821 return 0;
1822
1823 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1824 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1825 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1826 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1827
1828 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1829 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1830 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1831 if (dynamic != NULL)
1832 {
1833 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1834 size_t extdynsize;
1835 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1836
1837 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1838 return -1;
1839
1840 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1841 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1842
1843 extdyn = dynbuf;
1844 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1845 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1846 {
1847 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1848 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1849
1850 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1851 break;
1852
1853 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1854 {
1855 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1856 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1857 if (got != NULL
1858 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1859 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1860 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1861 break;
1862 }
1863 }
1864 free (dynbuf);
1865 }
1866
1867 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1868 if (glink_vma == 0)
1869 {
1870 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1871 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1872 }
1873
1874 if (glink_vma == 0)
1875 return 0;
1876
1877 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1878 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1879 glink stubs now reside. */
1880 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1881 if (glink == NULL)
1882 return 0;
1883
1884 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1885 from the first glink stub. */
1886 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1887 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1888 {
1889 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1890
1891 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1892 insn ^= B;
1893 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1894 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1895
1896 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1897 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1898 for (i = 4;
1899 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1900 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1901 i += 4)
1902 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1903 {
1904 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1905 break;
1906 }
1907 }
1908
1909 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1910 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1911 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1912 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1913 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1914 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1915 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1916 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1917 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1918 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1919 break;
1920 if (stub_delta > 32)
1921 return 0;
1922
1923 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1924 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1925 return -1;
1926
1927 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1928 p = relplt->relocation;
1929 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1930 {
1931 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1932 if (p->addend != 0)
1933 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1934 }
1935
1936 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1937
1938 if (resolv_vma)
1939 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1940
1941 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1942 if (s == NULL)
1943 return -1;
1944
1945 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1946 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1947 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1948 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1949 {
1950 size_t len;
1951
1952 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1953 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1954 stub_off -= 32;
1955 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1956 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1957 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1958 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1959 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1960 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1961 s->section = glink;
1962 s->value = stub_off;
1963 s->name = names;
1964 s->udata.p = NULL;
1965 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1966 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1967 names += len;
1968 if (p->addend != 0)
1969 {
1970 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1971 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1972 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1973 names += strlen (names);
1974 }
1975 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1976 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1977 ++s;
1978 --p;
1979 }
1980
1981 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1982 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1983 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1984 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1985 s->section = glink;
1986 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1987 s->name = names;
1988 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1989 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1990 s++;
1991 count++;
1992
1993 if (resolv_vma)
1994 {
1995 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1996 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1997 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1998 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1999 s->section = glink;
2000 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2001 s->name = names;
2002 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2003 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2004 s++;
2005 count++;
2006 }
2007
2008 return count;
2009 }
2010 \f
2011 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2012 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2013 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2014 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2015 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2016 called. */
2017
2018 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2019 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2020 struct plt_entry
2021 {
2022 struct plt_entry *next;
2023
2024 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2025 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2026 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2027 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2028 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2029 bfd_vma addend;
2030
2031 /* The .got2 section. */
2032 asection *sec;
2033
2034 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2035 union
2036 {
2037 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2038 bfd_vma offset;
2039 } plt;
2040
2041 /* .glink stub offset. */
2042 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2043 };
2044
2045 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2046 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2047 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2048
2049 static int
2050 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2051 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2052 {
2053 switch (r_type)
2054 {
2055 default:
2056 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2057 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2058 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2059 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2060 return 1;
2061
2062 case R_PPC_REL24:
2063 case R_PPC_REL14:
2064 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2065 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2066 case R_PPC_REL32:
2067 return 0;
2068
2069 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2070 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2071 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2072 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2073 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2074 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2075 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2076 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2077 }
2078 }
2079
2080 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2081 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2082 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2083 shared lib. */
2084 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2085
2086 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2087 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2088 {
2089 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2090
2091 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2092 asection *sec;
2093
2094 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2095 unsigned int count : 31;
2096
2097 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2098 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2099 };
2100
2101 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2102
2103 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2104 {
2105 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2106
2107 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2108 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2109 from the beginning of the section. */
2110 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2111
2112 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2113 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2114
2115 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2116 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2117 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2118 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2119 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2120 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2121 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2122 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2123 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2124 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2125 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2126 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2127 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2128 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2129 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2130 unsigned char tls_mask;
2131
2132 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2133 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2134 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2135 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2136 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2137
2138 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2139 symbol. */
2140 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2141
2142 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2143 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2144 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2145 };
2146
2147 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2148
2149 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2150
2151 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2152 {
2153 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2154
2155 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2156 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2157
2158 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2159 asection *glink;
2160 asection *dynsbss;
2161 asection *relsbss;
2162 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2163 asection *sbss;
2164 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2165 asection *pltlocal;
2166 asection *relpltlocal;
2167
2168 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2169 asection *srelplt2;
2170
2171 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2172 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2173
2174 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2175 bfd *old_bfd;
2176
2177 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2178 union {
2179 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2180 bfd_vma offset;
2181 } tlsld_got;
2182
2183 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2184 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2185
2186 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2187 unsigned int got_header_size;
2188 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2189 unsigned int got_gap;
2190
2191 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2192 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2193
2194 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2195 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2196
2197 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2198 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2199 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2200 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2201
2202 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2203 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2204
2205 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2206 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2207
2208 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2209 int plt_entry_size;
2210 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2211 int plt_slot_size;
2212 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2213 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2214
2215 /* Small local sym cache. */
2216 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2217 };
2218
2219 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2220 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2221
2222 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2223 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2224
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr. */
2226 #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
2227
2228 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2229 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2230
2231 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2232
2233 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2234 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2235 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2236
2237 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2238
2239 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2240 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2241 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2242 const char *string)
2243 {
2244 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2245 subclass. */
2246 if (entry == NULL)
2247 {
2248 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2249 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2250 if (entry == NULL)
2251 return entry;
2252 }
2253
2254 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2255 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2256 if (entry != NULL)
2257 {
2258 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2259 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2260 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2261 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2262 }
2263
2264 return entry;
2265 }
2266
2267 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2268
2269 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2270 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2271 {
2272 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2273 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2274 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2275
2276 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2277 if (ret == NULL)
2278 return NULL;
2279
2280 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2281 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2282 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2283 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2284 {
2285 free (ret);
2286 return NULL;
2287 }
2288
2289 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2290 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2291 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2292 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2293
2294 ret->params = &default_params;
2295
2296 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2297 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2298 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2299
2300 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2301 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2302 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2303
2304 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2305 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2306 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2307
2308 return &ret->elf.root;
2309 }
2310
2311 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2312
2313 void
2314 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2315 {
2316 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2317
2318 if (htab)
2319 htab->params = params;
2320 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2321 }
2322
2323 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2324
2325 static bfd_boolean
2326 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2327 {
2328 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2329
2330 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2331 return FALSE;
2332
2333 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2334 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2335 {
2336 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2337 executable. */
2338 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2339 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2340 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2341 return FALSE;
2342 }
2343
2344 return TRUE;
2345 }
2346
2347 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2348 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2349 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2350
2351 static bfd_boolean
2352 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2353 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2354 flagword flags,
2355 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2356 {
2357 asection *s;
2358
2359 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2360 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2361
2362 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2363 if (s == NULL)
2364 return FALSE;
2365 lsect->section = s;
2366
2367 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2368 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2369
2370 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2371 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2372 return FALSE;
2373 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2374 return TRUE;
2375 }
2376
2377 static bfd_boolean
2378 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2379 {
2380 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2381 asection *s;
2382 flagword flags;
2383 int p2align;
2384
2385 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2386 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2387 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2388 htab->glink = s;
2389 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2390 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2391 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2392 if (s == NULL
2393 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, p2align))
2394 return FALSE;
2395
2396 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2397 {
2398 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2399 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2400 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2401 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2402 if (s == NULL
2403 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2404 return FALSE;
2405 }
2406
2407 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2408 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2409 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2410 if (s == NULL
2411 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
2412 return FALSE;
2413
2414 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2415 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2416 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2417 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2418 if (s == NULL
2419 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2420 return FALSE;
2421
2422 /* Local plt entries. */
2423 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2424 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2425 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2426 flags);
2427 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2428 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->pltlocal, 2))
2429 return FALSE;
2430
2431 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2432 {
2433 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2434 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2435 htab->relpltlocal
2436 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2437 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2438 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2439 return FALSE;
2440 }
2441
2442 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2443 &htab->sdata[0]))
2444 return FALSE;
2445
2446 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2447 &htab->sdata[1]))
2448 return FALSE;
2449
2450 return TRUE;
2451 }
2452
2453 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2454 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2455 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2456
2457 static bfd_boolean
2458 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2459 {
2460 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2461 asection *s;
2462 flagword flags;
2463
2464 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2465
2466 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2467 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2468 return FALSE;
2469
2470 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2471 return FALSE;
2472
2473 if (htab->glink == NULL
2474 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2475 return FALSE;
2476
2477 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2478 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2479 htab->dynsbss = s;
2480 if (s == NULL)
2481 return FALSE;
2482
2483 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2484 {
2485 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2486 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2487 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2488 htab->relsbss = s;
2489 if (s == NULL
2490 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2491 return FALSE;
2492 }
2493
2494 if (htab->is_vxworks
2495 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2496 return FALSE;
2497
2498 s = htab->elf.splt;
2499 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2500 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2501 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2502 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2503 return bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags);
2504 }
2505
2506 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2507
2508 static void
2509 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2510 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2511 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2512 {
2513 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2514
2515 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2516 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2517
2518 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2519 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2520
2521 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2522 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2523 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2524 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2525 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2526 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2527 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2528
2529 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2530 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2531 return;
2532
2533 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2534 {
2535 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2536 {
2537 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2538 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2539
2540 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2541 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2542 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2543 {
2544 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2545
2546 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2547 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2548 {
2549 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2550 q->count += p->count;
2551 *pp = p->next;
2552 break;
2553 }
2554 if (q == NULL)
2555 pp = &p->next;
2556 }
2557 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2558 }
2559
2560 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2561 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2562 }
2563
2564 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2565 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2566 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2567 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2568
2569 /* And plt entries. */
2570 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2571 {
2572 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2573 {
2574 struct plt_entry **entp;
2575 struct plt_entry *ent;
2576
2577 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2578 {
2579 struct plt_entry *dent;
2580
2581 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2582 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2583 {
2584 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2585 *entp = ent->next;
2586 break;
2587 }
2588 if (dent == NULL)
2589 entp = &ent->next;
2590 }
2591 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2592 }
2593
2594 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2595 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2596 }
2597
2598 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2599 {
2600 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2601 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2602 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2603 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2604 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2605 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2606 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2607 }
2608 }
2609
2610 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2611 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2612
2613 static bfd_boolean
2614 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2615 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2616 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2617 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2618 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2619 asection **secp,
2620 bfd_vma *valp)
2621 {
2622 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2623 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2624 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2625 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2626 {
2627 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2628 put into .sbss. */
2629 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2630
2631 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2632 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2633 {
2634 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2635
2636 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2637 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2638
2639 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2640 ".sbss",
2641 flags);
2642 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2643 return FALSE;
2644 }
2645
2646 *secp = htab->sbss;
2647 *valp = sym->st_size;
2648 }
2649
2650 return TRUE;
2651 }
2652 \f
2653 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2654
2655 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2656 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2657 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2658 bfd_vma addend,
2659 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2660 {
2661 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2662 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2663 return linker_pointers;
2664
2665 return NULL;
2666 }
2667
2668 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2669
2670 static bfd_boolean
2671 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2672 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2673 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2674 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2675 {
2676 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2677 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2678 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2679 bfd_size_type amt;
2680
2681 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2682
2683 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2684 if (h != NULL)
2685 {
2686 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2687
2688 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2689 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2690 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2691 rel->r_addend,
2692 lsect))
2693 return TRUE;
2694
2695 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2696 }
2697 else
2698 {
2699 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2700
2701 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2702 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2703
2704 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2705 if (!ptr)
2706 {
2707 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2708
2709 amt = num_symbols;
2710 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2711 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2712
2713 if (!ptr)
2714 return FALSE;
2715
2716 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2717 }
2718
2719 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2720 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2721 rel->r_addend,
2722 lsect))
2723 return TRUE;
2724
2725 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2726 }
2727
2728 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2729 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2730 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2731 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2732 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2733
2734 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2735 return FALSE;
2736
2737 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2738 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2739 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2740 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2741
2742 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section->owner, lsect->section, 2))
2743 return FALSE;
2744 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2745 lsect->section->size += 4;
2746
2747 #ifdef DEBUG
2748 fprintf (stderr,
2749 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2750 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2751 (long) lsect->section->size);
2752 #endif
2753
2754 return TRUE;
2755 }
2756
2757 static struct plt_entry **
2758 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2759 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2760 unsigned long r_symndx,
2761 int tls_type)
2762 {
2763 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2764 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2765 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2766
2767 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2768 {
2769 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2770
2771 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2772 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2773 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2774 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2775 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2776 return NULL;
2777 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2778 }
2779
2780 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2781 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2782 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2783 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2784 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2785 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2786 }
2787
2788 static bfd_boolean
2789 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2790 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2791 {
2792 struct plt_entry *ent;
2793
2794 if (addend < 32768)
2795 sec = NULL;
2796 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2797 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2798 break;
2799 if (ent == NULL)
2800 {
2801 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2802 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2803 if (ent == NULL)
2804 return FALSE;
2805 ent->next = *plist;
2806 ent->sec = sec;
2807 ent->addend = addend;
2808 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2809 *plist = ent;
2810 }
2811 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2812 return TRUE;
2813 }
2814
2815 static struct plt_entry *
2816 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2817 {
2818 struct plt_entry *ent;
2819
2820 if (addend < 32768)
2821 sec = NULL;
2822 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2823 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2824 break;
2825 return ent;
2826 }
2827
2828 static bfd_boolean
2829 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2830 {
2831 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2832 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2835 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2840 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2841 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2842 }
2843
2844 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2845
2846 static bfd_boolean
2847 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2848 {
2849 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2850 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2851 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2852 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2853 }
2854
2855 static void
2856 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2857 {
2858 _bfd_error_handler
2859 /* xgettext:c-format */
2860 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2861 abfd,
2862 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2863 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2864 }
2865
2866 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2867 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2868 table. */
2869
2870 static bfd_boolean
2871 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2872 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2873 asection *sec,
2874 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2875 {
2876 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2877 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2878 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2879 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2880 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2881 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2882 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2883
2884 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2885 return TRUE;
2886
2887 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2888 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2889 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2890 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2891 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2892 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2893 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2894 return TRUE;
2895
2896 #ifdef DEBUG
2897 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2898 sec, abfd);
2899 #endif
2900
2901 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2902
2903 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2904 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2905 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2906
2907 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2908 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2909 {
2910 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2911 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2912 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2913 return FALSE;
2914 }
2915 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2916 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2917 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2918 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2919 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2920 sreloc = NULL;
2921
2922 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2923 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2924 {
2925 unsigned long r_symndx;
2926 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2927 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2928 int tls_type;
2929 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2930 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2931 bfd_vma addend;
2932
2933 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2934 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2935 h = NULL;
2936 else
2937 {
2938 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2939 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2940 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2941 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2942 }
2943
2944 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2945 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2946 startup code. */
2947 if (h != NULL
2948 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2949 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2950 {
2951 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2952 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2953 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2954 return FALSE;
2955 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2956 }
2957
2958 tls_type = 0;
2959 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2960 ifunc = NULL;
2961 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2962 {
2963 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2964 abfd, r_symndx);
2965 if (isym == NULL)
2966 return FALSE;
2967
2968 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2969 {
2970 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2971 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2972 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2973 if (ifunc == NULL)
2974 return FALSE;
2975
2976 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2977 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2978 no plt calls. */
2979 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2980 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2981 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2982 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2983 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2984 {
2985 addend = 0;
2986 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2987 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2988 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2989 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2990 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2991 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2992 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2993 addend = rel->r_addend;
2994 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2995 return FALSE;
2996 }
2997 }
2998 }
2999
3000 if (!htab->is_vxworks
3001 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3002 && h != NULL
3003 && h == tga)
3004 {
3005 if (rel != relocs
3006 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3007 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3008 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3009 reloc. */
3010 ;
3011 else
3012 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3013 sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
3014 }
3015
3016 switch (r_type)
3017 {
3018 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3019 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3020 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3021 its parameter symbol. */
3022 if (h != NULL)
3023 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3024 else
3025 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3026 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3027 return FALSE;
3028 break;
3029
3030 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3031 break;
3032
3033 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3034 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3035 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3037 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3038 goto dogottls;
3039
3040 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3041 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3042 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3043 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3044 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3045 goto dogottls;
3046
3047 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3048 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3049 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3050 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3051 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3052 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3053 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3054 goto dogottls;
3055
3056 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3057 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3058 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3059 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3060 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3061 dogottls:
3062 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3063 /* Fall through. */
3064
3065 /* GOT16 relocations */
3066 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3067 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3068 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3069 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3070 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3071 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3072 {
3073 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3074 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3075 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3076 return FALSE;
3077 }
3078 if (h != NULL)
3079 {
3080 h->got.refcount += 1;
3081 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3082 }
3083 else
3084 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3085 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3086 return FALSE;
3087
3088 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3089 an ifunc. */
3090 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3091 {
3092 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3093 return FALSE;
3094 }
3095 break;
3096
3097 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3098 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3099 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3100 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3101 h, rel))
3102 return FALSE;
3103 if (h != NULL)
3104 {
3105 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3106 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3107 }
3108 break;
3109
3110 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3111 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3112 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3113 {
3114 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3115 return FALSE;
3116 }
3117 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3118 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3119 h, rel))
3120 return FALSE;
3121 if (h != NULL)
3122 {
3123 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3124 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3125 }
3126 break;
3127
3128 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3129 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3130 /* Fall through. */
3131
3132 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3133 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3134 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3135 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3136 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3138 if (h != NULL)
3139 {
3140 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3141 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3142 }
3143 break;
3144
3145 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3146 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3147 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3148 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3153 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3154 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3155 break;
3156
3157 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3158 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3159 {
3160 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3161 return FALSE;
3162 }
3163 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3164 if (h != NULL)
3165 {
3166 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3167 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3168 }
3169 break;
3170
3171 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3172 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3173 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3174 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3175 if (h != NULL)
3176 {
3177 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3178 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3179 }
3180 break;
3181
3182 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3183 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3184 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3185 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3186 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3187 if (h != NULL)
3188 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3189 break;
3190
3191 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3192 if (h == NULL)
3193 break;
3194 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3195 goto pltentry;
3196
3197 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3198 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3199 /* Fall through. */
3200
3201 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3202 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3203 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3204 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3205 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3206 pltentry:
3207 #ifdef DEBUG
3208 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3209 #endif
3210 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3211 if (h == NULL)
3212 {
3213 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3214 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3215 if (pltent == NULL)
3216 return FALSE;
3217 }
3218 else
3219 {
3220 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3221 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3222 h->needs_plt = 1;
3223 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3224 }
3225 addend = 0;
3226 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3227 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3228 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3229 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3230 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3231 addend = rel->r_addend;
3232 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3233 return FALSE;
3234 break;
3235
3236 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3237 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3238 section relative. */
3239 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3240 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3241 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3242 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3243 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3244 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3245 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3246 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3247 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3248 break;
3249
3250 case R_PPC_REL16:
3251 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3252 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3253 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3254 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3255 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3256 break;
3257
3258 /* These are just markers. */
3259 case R_PPC_TLS:
3260 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3261 case R_PPC_NONE:
3262 case R_PPC_max:
3263 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3264 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3265 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3266 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3267 break;
3268
3269 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3270 case R_PPC_COPY:
3271 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3272 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3273 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3274 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3275 break;
3276
3277 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3278 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3279 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3280 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3281 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3282 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3283 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3284 break;
3285
3286 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3287 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3288 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3289 {
3290 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3291 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3292 }
3293 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3294 {
3295 h->needs_plt = 1;
3296 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3297 return FALSE;
3298 }
3299 break;
3300
3301 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3302 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3303 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3304 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3305 return FALSE;
3306 break;
3307
3308 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3309 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3310 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3311 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3312 return FALSE;
3313 break;
3314
3315 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3316 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3317 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3318 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3319 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3320 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3321 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3322 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3323 goto dodyn;
3324
3325 /* Nor these. */
3326 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3327 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3328 goto dodyn;
3329
3330 case R_PPC_REL32:
3331 if (h == NULL
3332 && got2 != NULL
3333 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3334 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3335 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3336 {
3337 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3338 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3339 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3340 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3341 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3342 PLT call stubs. */
3343 asection *s;
3344 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3345
3346 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3347 abfd, r_symndx);
3348 if (isym == NULL)
3349 return FALSE;
3350
3351 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3352 if (s == got2)
3353 {
3354 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3355 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3356 }
3357 }
3358 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3359 break;
3360 /* fall through */
3361
3362 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3363 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3364 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3365 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3366 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3367 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3368 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3369 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3370 {
3371 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3372 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3373 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3374 return FALSE;
3375
3376 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3377 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3378 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3379 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3380 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3381 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3382 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3383 }
3384 goto dodyn;
3385
3386 case R_PPC_REL24:
3387 case R_PPC_REL14:
3388 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3389 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3390 if (h == NULL)
3391 break;
3392 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3393 {
3394 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3395 {
3396 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3397 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3398 }
3399 break;
3400 }
3401 /* fall through */
3402
3403 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3404 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3405 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3406 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3407 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3408 {
3409 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3410 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3411 h->needs_plt = 1;
3412 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3413 return FALSE;
3414 break;
3415 }
3416
3417 dodyn:
3418 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3419 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3420 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3421 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3422 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3423 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3424 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3425 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3426 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3427 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3428 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3429 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3430 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3431 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3432 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3433 symbol local.
3434
3435 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3436 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3437 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3438 symbol. */
3439 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3440 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3441 || (h != NULL
3442 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3443 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3444 || !h->def_regular))))
3445 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3446 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3447 && h != NULL
3448 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3449 || !h->def_regular)))
3450 {
3451 #ifdef DEBUG
3452 fprintf (stderr,
3453 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3454 "create relocation for %s\n",
3455 (h && h->root.root.string
3456 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3457 #endif
3458 if (sreloc == NULL)
3459 {
3460 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3461 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3462
3463 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3464 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3465
3466 if (sreloc == NULL)
3467 return FALSE;
3468 }
3469
3470 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3471 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3472 if (h != NULL)
3473 {
3474 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3475 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3476
3477 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3478 p = *rel_head;
3479 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3480 {
3481 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3482 if (p == NULL)
3483 return FALSE;
3484 p->next = *rel_head;
3485 *rel_head = p;
3486 p->sec = sec;
3487 p->count = 0;
3488 p->pc_count = 0;
3489 }
3490 p->count += 1;
3491 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3492 p->pc_count += 1;
3493 }
3494 else
3495 {
3496 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3497 We really need local syms available to do this
3498 easily. Oh well. */
3499 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3500 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3501 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3502 asection *s;
3503 void *vpp;
3504 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3505
3506 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3507 abfd, r_symndx);
3508 if (isym == NULL)
3509 return FALSE;
3510
3511 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3512 if (s == NULL)
3513 s = sec;
3514
3515 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3516 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3517 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3518 p = *rel_head;
3519 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3520 p = p->next;
3521 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3522 {
3523 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3524 if (p == NULL)
3525 return FALSE;
3526 p->next = *rel_head;
3527 *rel_head = p;
3528 p->sec = sec;
3529 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3530 p->count = 0;
3531 }
3532 p->count += 1;
3533 }
3534 }
3535
3536 break;
3537 }
3538 }
3539
3540 return TRUE;
3541 }
3542 \f
3543 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3544 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3545 bfd_boolean
3546 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3547 {
3548 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3549 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3550 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3551 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3552
3553 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3554 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3555
3556 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3557 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3558
3559 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3560 {
3561 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3562 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3563 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3564
3565 if (in_fp == 0)
3566 ;
3567 else if (out_fp == 0)
3568 {
3569 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3570 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3571 last_fp = ibfd;
3572 }
3573 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3574 {
3575 _bfd_error_handler
3576 /* xgettext:c-format */
3577 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3578 last_fp, ibfd);
3579 ret = FALSE;
3580 }
3581 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3582 {
3583 _bfd_error_handler
3584 /* xgettext:c-format */
3585 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3586 ibfd, last_fp);
3587 ret = FALSE;
3588 }
3589 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3590 {
3591 _bfd_error_handler
3592 /* xgettext:c-format */
3593 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3594 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3595 ret = FALSE;
3596 }
3597 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3598 {
3599 _bfd_error_handler
3600 /* xgettext:c-format */
3601 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3602 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3603 ret = FALSE;
3604 }
3605
3606 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3607 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3608 if (in_fp == 0)
3609 ;
3610 else if (out_fp == 0)
3611 {
3612 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3613 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3614 last_ld = ibfd;
3615 }
3616 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3617 {
3618 _bfd_error_handler
3619 /* xgettext:c-format */
3620 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3621 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3622 ret = FALSE;
3623 }
3624 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3625 {
3626 _bfd_error_handler
3627 /* xgettext:c-format */
3628 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3629 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3630 ret = FALSE;
3631 }
3632 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3633 {
3634 _bfd_error_handler
3635 /* xgettext:c-format */
3636 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3637 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3638 ret = FALSE;
3639 }
3640 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3641 {
3642 _bfd_error_handler
3643 /* xgettext:c-format */
3644 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3645 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3646 ret = FALSE;
3647 }
3648 }
3649
3650 if (!ret)
3651 {
3652 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3653 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3654 }
3655 return ret;
3656 }
3657
3658 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3659 there are conflicting attributes. */
3660 static bfd_boolean
3661 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3662 {
3663 bfd *obfd;
3664 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3665 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3666 bfd_boolean ret;
3667
3668 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3669 return FALSE;
3670
3671 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3672 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3673 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3674
3675 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3676 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3677 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3678 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3679 ret = TRUE;
3680 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3681 {
3682 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3683 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3684 static bfd *last_vec;
3685
3686 if (in_vec == 0)
3687 ;
3688 else if (out_vec == 0)
3689 {
3690 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3691 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3692 last_vec = ibfd;
3693 }
3694 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3695 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3696 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3697 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3698 case too. */
3699 else if (in_vec == 1)
3700 ;
3701 else if (out_vec == 1)
3702 {
3703 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3704 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3705 last_vec = ibfd;
3706 }
3707 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3708 {
3709 _bfd_error_handler
3710 /* xgettext:c-format */
3711 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3712 last_vec, ibfd);
3713 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3714 ret = FALSE;
3715 }
3716 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3717 {
3718 _bfd_error_handler
3719 /* xgettext:c-format */
3720 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3721 ibfd, last_vec);
3722 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3723 ret = FALSE;
3724 }
3725 }
3726
3727 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3728 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3729 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3730 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3731 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3732 {
3733 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3734 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3735 static bfd *last_struct;
3736
3737 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3738 ;
3739 else if (out_struct == 0)
3740 {
3741 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3742 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3743 last_struct = ibfd;
3744 }
3745 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3746 {
3747 _bfd_error_handler
3748 /* xgettext:c-format */
3749 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3750 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3751 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3752 ret = FALSE;
3753 }
3754 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3755 {
3756 _bfd_error_handler
3757 /* xgettext:c-format */
3758 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3759 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3760 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3761 ret = FALSE;
3762 }
3763 }
3764 if (!ret)
3765 {
3766 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3767 return FALSE;
3768 }
3769
3770 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3771 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3772 }
3773
3774 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3775 object file when linking. */
3776
3777 static bfd_boolean
3778 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3779 {
3780 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3781 flagword old_flags;
3782 flagword new_flags;
3783 bfd_boolean error;
3784
3785 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3786 return TRUE;
3787
3788 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3789 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3790 return FALSE;
3791
3792 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3793 return FALSE;
3794
3795 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3796 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3797 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3798 {
3799 /* First call, no flags set. */
3800 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3801 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3802 }
3803
3804 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3805 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3806 ;
3807
3808 /* Incompatible flags. */
3809 else
3810 {
3811 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3812 to be linked with either. */
3813 error = FALSE;
3814 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3815 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3816 {
3817 error = TRUE;
3818 _bfd_error_handler
3819 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3820 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3821 }
3822 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3823 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3824 {
3825 error = TRUE;
3826 _bfd_error_handler
3827 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3828 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3829 }
3830
3831 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3832 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3833 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3834
3835 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3836 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3837 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3838 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3839 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3840 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3841
3842 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3843 any module uses it. */
3844 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3845
3846 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3847 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3848
3849 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3850 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3851 {
3852 error = TRUE;
3853 _bfd_error_handler
3854 /* xgettext:c-format */
3855 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3856 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3857 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3858 }
3859
3860 if (error)
3861 {
3862 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3863 return FALSE;
3864 }
3865 }
3866
3867 return TRUE;
3868 }
3869
3870 static void
3871 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3872 asection *input_section,
3873 unsigned long offset,
3874 bfd_byte *loc,
3875 bfd_vma value,
3876 split16_format_type split16_format,
3877 bfd_boolean fixup)
3878 {
3879 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3880
3881 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3882 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3883 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3884 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3885 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3886 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3887 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3888 {
3889 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3890 {
3891 if (fixup)
3892 split16_format = split16a_type;
3893 else
3894 _bfd_error_handler
3895 /* xgettext:c-format */
3896 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3897 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3898 }
3899 }
3900 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3901 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3902 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3903 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3904 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3905 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3906 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3907 {
3908 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3909 {
3910 if (fixup)
3911 split16_format = split16d_type;
3912 else
3913 _bfd_error_handler
3914 /* xgettext:c-format */
3915 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3916 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3917 }
3918 }
3919 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3920 {
3921 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3922 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3923 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3924 {
3925 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3926 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3927 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3928 }
3929 }
3930 else
3931 {
3932 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3933 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3934 }
3935 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3936 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3937 }
3938
3939 static void
3940 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3941 {
3942 unsigned int insn;
3943
3944 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3945 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3946 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3947 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3948 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3949 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3950 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3951 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3952 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3953 }
3954
3955 \f
3956 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3957 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3958 int
3959 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3960 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3961 {
3962 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3963 flagword flags;
3964
3965 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3966
3967 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3968 {
3969 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3970
3971 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3972 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3973 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3974 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3975 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3976 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3977 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3978 || h->needs_plt)
3979 && h->ref_regular
3980 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3981 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3982 {
3983 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3984 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3985 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3986 r30 to be set up. */
3987 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3988 }
3989 else
3990 {
3991 bfd *ibfd;
3992 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
3993
3994 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
3995 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
3996 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
3997 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
3998 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3999 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4000 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4001 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4002 {
4003 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4004 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4005 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4006 {
4007 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4008 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4009 break;
4010 }
4011 }
4012 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4013 }
4014 }
4015 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4016 {
4017 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4018 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4019 else
4020 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4021 }
4022
4023 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4024
4025 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4026 {
4027 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4028 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4029
4030 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4031 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4032 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.splt, flags))
4033 return -1;
4034
4035 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4036 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4037 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4038 return -1;
4039 }
4040 else
4041 {
4042 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4043 if (htab->glink != NULL
4044 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink, 0))
4045 return -1;
4046 }
4047 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4048 }
4049 \f
4050 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4051 relocation. */
4052
4053 static asection *
4054 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4055 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4056 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4057 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4058 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4059 {
4060 if (h != NULL)
4061 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4062 {
4063 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4064 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4065 return NULL;
4066 }
4067
4068 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4069 }
4070
4071 static bfd_boolean
4072 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4073 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4074 asection **symsecp,
4075 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4076 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4077 unsigned long r_symndx,
4078 bfd *ibfd)
4079 {
4080 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4081
4082 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4083 {
4084 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4085 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4086
4087 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4088 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4089 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4090 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4091
4092 if (hp != NULL)
4093 *hp = h;
4094
4095 if (symp != NULL)
4096 *symp = NULL;
4097
4098 if (symsecp != NULL)
4099 {
4100 asection *symsec = NULL;
4101 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4102 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4103 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4104 *symsecp = symsec;
4105 }
4106
4107 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4108 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4109 }
4110 else
4111 {
4112 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4113 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4114
4115 if (locsyms == NULL)
4116 {
4117 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4118 if (locsyms == NULL)
4119 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4120 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4121 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4122 if (locsyms == NULL)
4123 return FALSE;
4124 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4125 }
4126 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4127
4128 if (hp != NULL)
4129 *hp = NULL;
4130
4131 if (symp != NULL)
4132 *symp = sym;
4133
4134 if (symsecp != NULL)
4135 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4136
4137 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4138 {
4139 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4140 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4141
4142 tls_mask = NULL;
4143 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4144 if (local_got != NULL)
4145 {
4146 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4147 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4148 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4149 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4150 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4151 }
4152 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4153 }
4154 }
4155 return TRUE;
4156 }
4157 \f
4158 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4159 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4160
4161 bfd_boolean
4162 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4163 {
4164 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4165 bfd *ibfd;
4166 asection *sec;
4167 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4168
4169 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4170 if (htab == NULL)
4171 return FALSE;
4172
4173 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4174 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4175 between the call and its destination. */
4176 limit = 0x1e00000;
4177 low_vma = -1;
4178 high_vma = 0;
4179 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4180 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4181 {
4182 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4183 low_vma = sec->vma;
4184 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4185 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4186 }
4187
4188 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4189 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4190 is local. */
4191 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4192 {
4193 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4194 return TRUE;
4195 }
4196
4197 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4198 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4199 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4200 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4201 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4202 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4203 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4204 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4205 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4206 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4207 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4208 together except their symbol. */
4209
4210 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4211 {
4212 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4213 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4214
4215 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4216 continue;
4217
4218 local_syms = NULL;
4219 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4220
4221 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4222 if (sec->has_pltcall
4223 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4224 {
4225 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4226
4227 /* Read the relocations. */
4228 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4229 info->keep_memory);
4230 if (relstart == NULL)
4231 return FALSE;
4232
4233 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4234 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4235 {
4236 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4237 unsigned long r_symndx;
4238 asection *sym_sec;
4239 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4240 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4241 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4242
4243 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4244 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4245 continue;
4246
4247 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4248 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4249 r_symndx, ibfd))
4250 {
4251 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4252 free (relstart);
4253 if (local_syms != NULL
4254 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4255 free (local_syms);
4256 return FALSE;
4257 }
4258
4259 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4260 {
4261 bfd_vma from, to;
4262 if (h != NULL)
4263 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4264 else
4265 to = sym->st_value;
4266 to += (rel->r_addend
4267 + sym_sec->output_offset
4268 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4269 from = (rel->r_offset
4270 + sec->output_offset
4271 + sec->output_section->vma);
4272 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4273 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4274 }
4275 }
4276 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4277 free (relstart);
4278 }
4279
4280 if (local_syms != NULL
4281 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4282 {
4283 if (!info->keep_memory)
4284 free (local_syms);
4285 else
4286 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4287 }
4288 }
4289
4290 return TRUE;
4291 }
4292
4293 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4294 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4295
4296 asection *
4297 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4298 {
4299 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4300
4301 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4302 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4303 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4304 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4305 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4306
4307 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4308 {
4309 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4310 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4311 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4312 if (opt != NULL
4313 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4314 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4315 {
4316 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4317 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4318 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4319 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4320 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4321 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4322 && tga != NULL
4323 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4324 || tga->needs_plt)
4325 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4326 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4327 {
4328 struct plt_entry *ent;
4329 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4330 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4331 break;
4332 if (ent != NULL)
4333 {
4334 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4335 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4336 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4337 opt->mark = 1;
4338 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4339 {
4340 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4341 opt->dynindx = -1;
4342 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4343 opt->dynstr_index);
4344 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4345 return FALSE;
4346 }
4347 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4348 }
4349 }
4350 }
4351 else
4352 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4353 }
4354 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4355 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4356 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4357 {
4358 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4359 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4360 }
4361
4362 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4363 }
4364
4365 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4366 HASH. */
4367
4368 static bfd_boolean
4369 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4370 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4371 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4372 {
4373 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4374 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4375 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4376
4377 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4378 {
4379 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4380 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4381
4382 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4383 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4384 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4385 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4386 if (h == hash)
4387 return TRUE;
4388 }
4389 return FALSE;
4390 }
4391
4392 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4393 opportunities. */
4394
4395 bfd_boolean
4396 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4397 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4398 {
4399 bfd *ibfd;
4400 asection *sec;
4401 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4402 int pass;
4403
4404 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4405 return TRUE;
4406
4407 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4408 if (htab == NULL)
4409 return FALSE;
4410
4411 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4412 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4413 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4414 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4415 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4416 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4417 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4418 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4419 {
4420 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4421 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4422
4423 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4424 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4425 {
4426 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4427 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4428
4429 /* Read the relocations. */
4430 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4431 info->keep_memory);
4432 if (relstart == NULL)
4433 return FALSE;
4434
4435 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4436 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4437 {
4438 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4439 unsigned long r_symndx;
4440 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4441 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4442 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4443 bfd_boolean is_local;
4444 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4445
4446 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4447 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4448 {
4449 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4450
4451 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4452 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4453 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4454 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4455 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4456 }
4457
4458 is_local = FALSE;
4459 if (h == NULL
4460 || !h->def_dynamic)
4461 is_local = TRUE;
4462
4463 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4464 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4465 without marker relocs, then check that each
4466 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4467 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4468 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4469 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4470 if (pass == 0
4471 && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4472 && h != NULL
4473 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4474 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4475 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4476 {
4477 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4478 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4479 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4480 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4481 free (relstart);
4482 return TRUE;
4483 }
4484
4485 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4486 switch (r_type)
4487 {
4488 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4489 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4490 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4491 /* Fall through. */
4492
4493 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4494 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4495 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4496 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4497 that turns out to be the case. */
4498 if (!is_local)
4499 continue;
4500
4501 /* LD -> LE */
4502 tls_set = 0;
4503 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4504 break;
4505
4506 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4507 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4508 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4509 /* Fall through. */
4510
4511 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4512 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4513 if (is_local)
4514 /* GD -> LE */
4515 tls_set = 0;
4516 else
4517 /* GD -> IE */
4518 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4519 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4520 break;
4521
4522 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4523 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4524 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4525 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4526 if (is_local)
4527 {
4528 /* IE -> LE */
4529 tls_set = 0;
4530 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4531 break;
4532 }
4533 else
4534 continue;
4535
4536 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4537 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4538 if (rel + 1 < relend
4539 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4540 {
4541 if (pass != 0
4542 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4543 {
4544 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4545 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4546 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4547 {
4548 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4549
4550 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4551 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4552 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4553 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4554 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4555 if (h != NULL)
4556 {
4557 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4558 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4559
4560 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4561 addend = rel->r_addend;
4562 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4563 got2, addend);
4564 if (ent != NULL
4565 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4566 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4567 }
4568 }
4569 }
4570 continue;
4571 }
4572 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4573 tls_set = 0;
4574 tls_clear = 0;
4575 break;
4576
4577 default:
4578 continue;
4579 }
4580
4581 if (pass == 0)
4582 {
4583 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4584 || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
4585 continue;
4586
4587 if (rel + 1 < relend
4588 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4589 htab->tls_get_addr))
4590 continue;
4591
4592 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4593 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4594 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4595 the entire optimization. */
4596 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4597 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4598 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4599 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4600 free (relstart);
4601 return TRUE;
4602 }
4603
4604 if (h != NULL)
4605 {
4606 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4607 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4608 }
4609 else
4610 {
4611 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4612 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4613 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4614
4615 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4616 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4617 abort ();
4618 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4619 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4620 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4621 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4622 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4623 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4624 }
4625
4626 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4627 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4628 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4629 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4630 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4631 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4632 Disable optimization in this case. */
4633 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4634 && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4635 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4636 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4637 continue;
4638
4639 if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
4640 {
4641 struct plt_entry *ent;
4642 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4643
4644 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4645 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4646 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4647 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4648 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4649 got2, addend);
4650 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4651 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4652
4653 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
4654 continue;
4655 }
4656
4657 if (tls_set == 0)
4658 {
4659 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4660 if (*got_count > 0)
4661 *got_count -= 1;
4662 }
4663
4664 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4665 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4666 }
4667
4668 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4669 free (relstart);
4670 }
4671 }
4672 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4673 return TRUE;
4674 }
4675 \f
4676 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4677
4678 static asection *
4679 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4680 {
4681 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4682
4683 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4684 {
4685 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4686
4687 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4688 return p->sec;
4689 }
4690 return NULL;
4691 }
4692
4693 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4694 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4695 size_dynamic_sections. */
4696
4697 static bfd_boolean
4698 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4699 {
4700 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4701 do
4702 {
4703 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4704 return TRUE;
4705 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4706 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4707
4708 return FALSE;
4709 }
4710
4711 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4712
4713 static bfd_boolean
4714 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4715 {
4716 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4717
4718 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4719 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4720 return TRUE;
4721 return FALSE;
4722 }
4723
4724 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4725 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4726 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4727 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4728 understand. */
4729
4730 static bfd_boolean
4731 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4732 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4733 {
4734 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4735 asection *s;
4736
4737 #ifdef DEBUG
4738 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4739 h->root.root.string);
4740 #endif
4741
4742 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4743 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4744 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4745 && (h->needs_plt
4746 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4747 || h->is_weakalias
4748 || (h->def_dynamic
4749 && h->ref_regular
4750 && !h->def_regular)));
4751
4752 /* Deal with function syms. */
4753 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4754 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4755 || h->needs_plt)
4756 {
4757 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4758 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4759 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4760 function symbol is local. */
4761 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4762 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4763
4764 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4765 won't need a .plt entry. */
4766 struct plt_entry *ent;
4767 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4768 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4769 break;
4770 if (ent == NULL
4771 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4772 && local
4773 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4774 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4775 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4776 {
4777 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4778
4779 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4780 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4781 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4782
4783 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4784
4785 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4786 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4787 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4788 h->needs_plt = 0;
4789 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4790 }
4791 else
4792 {
4793 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4794 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4795 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4796 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4797 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4798 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4799 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4800 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4801 than link time. */
4802 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4803 || (h->non_got_ref
4804 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4805 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4806 && !htab->is_vxworks
4807 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4808 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4809 {
4810 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4811 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4812 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4813 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4814 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4815 }
4816 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4817 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4818 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4819 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4820 }
4821 h->protected_def = 0;
4822 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4823 return TRUE;
4824 }
4825 else
4826 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4827
4828 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4829 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4830 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4831 if (h->is_weakalias)
4832 {
4833 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4834 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4835 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4836 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4837 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4838 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4839 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4840 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4841 return TRUE;
4842 }
4843
4844 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4845 is not a function. */
4846
4847 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4848 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4849 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4850 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4851 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4852 {
4853 h->protected_def = 0;
4854 return TRUE;
4855 }
4856
4857 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4858 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4859 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4860 {
4861 h->protected_def = 0;
4862 return TRUE;
4863 }
4864
4865 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4866 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4867 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4868 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4869 if (h->protected_def)
4870 {
4871 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4872 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4873 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4874 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4875 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4876 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4877 return TRUE;
4878 }
4879
4880 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4881 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4882 return TRUE;
4883
4884 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4885 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4886 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4887 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4888 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4889 executable. */
4890 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4891 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4892 && !htab->is_vxworks
4893 && !h->def_regular
4894 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4895 return TRUE;
4896
4897 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4898 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4899 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4900 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4901 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4902 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4903 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4904 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4905 same memory location for the variable.
4906
4907 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4908 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4909 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4910 s = htab->dynsbss;
4911 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4912 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4913 else
4914 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4915 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4916
4917 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4918 {
4919 asection *srel;
4920
4921 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4922 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4923 and into the runtime process image. */
4924 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4925 srel = htab->relsbss;
4926 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4927 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4928 else
4929 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4930 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4931 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4932 h->needs_copy = 1;
4933 }
4934
4935 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4936 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4937 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4938 }
4939 \f
4940 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4941 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4942 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4943 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4944 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4945
4946 static bfd_boolean
4947 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4948 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4949 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4950 {
4951 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4952 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4953 char *name;
4954 const char *stub;
4955 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4956
4957 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4958 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4959 else
4960 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4961
4962 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4963 len2 = strlen (stub);
4964 len3 = 0;
4965 if (ent->sec)
4966 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4967 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4968 if (name == NULL)
4969 return FALSE;
4970 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4971 if (ent->sec)
4972 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4973 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4974 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4975 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4976 if (sh == NULL)
4977 return FALSE;
4978 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4979 {
4980 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4981 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4982 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4983 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4984 sh->def_regular = 1;
4985 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4986 sh->forced_local = 1;
4987 sh->non_elf = 0;
4988 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4989 }
4990 return TRUE;
4991 }
4992
4993 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
4994 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
4995
4996 static bfd_vma
4997 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
4998 {
4999 bfd_vma where;
5000 unsigned int max_before_header;
5001
5002 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5003 {
5004 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5005 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5006 }
5007 else
5008 {
5009 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5010 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5011 {
5012 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5013 htab->got_gap -= need;
5014 }
5015 else
5016 {
5017 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5018 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5019 {
5020 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5021 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5022 }
5023 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5024 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5025 }
5026 }
5027 return where;
5028 }
5029
5030 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5031 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5032
5033 static inline unsigned int
5034 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5035 {
5036 unsigned int need;
5037 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5038 need = 4;
5039 else
5040 {
5041 need = 0;
5042 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5043 need += 8;
5044 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5045 need += 4;
5046 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5047 need += 4;
5048 }
5049 return need;
5050 }
5051
5052 /* Calculate size of relocs needed for symbol given its TLS_MASK and
5053 NEEDed GOT entries. KNOWN says a TPREL offset can be calculated at
5054 link time. */
5055
5056 static inline unsigned int
5057 got_relocs_needed (int tls_mask, unsigned int need, bfd_boolean known)
5058 {
5059 /* All the entries we allocated need relocs.
5060 Except IE in executable with a local symbol. We could also omit
5061 the DTPREL reloc on the second word of a GD entry under the same
5062 condition as that for IE, but ld.so needs to differentiate
5063 LD and GD entries. */
5064 if (known && (tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5065 && (tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5066 need -= 4;
5067 return need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5068 }
5069
5070 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5071
5072 static bfd_boolean
5073 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5074 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5075 {
5076 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5077
5078 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5079 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5080 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5081 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5082 && h->dynindx == -1
5083 && !h->forced_local
5084 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5085 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5086 return TRUE;
5087 }
5088
5089 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5090
5091 static bfd_boolean
5092 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5093 {
5094 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5095 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5096 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5097 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5098 bfd_boolean dyn;
5099
5100 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5101 return TRUE;
5102
5103 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5104 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5105 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5106 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5107 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5108 && eh->elf.protected_def
5109 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5110 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5111 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5112 {
5113 unsigned int need;
5114
5115 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5116 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5117 return FALSE;
5118
5119 need = 0;
5120 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5121 {
5122 if (!eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5123 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5124 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5125 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5126 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5127 else
5128 need += 8;
5129 }
5130 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5131 if (need == 0)
5132 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5133 else
5134 {
5135 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5136 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
5137 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5138 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5139 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5140 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5141 {
5142 asection *rsec;
5143 bfd_boolean tprel_known = (bfd_link_executable (info)
5144 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info,
5145 &eh->elf));
5146
5147 need = got_relocs_needed (eh->tls_mask, need, tprel_known);
5148 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
5149 && eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5150 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5151 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5152 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5153 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5154 rsec->size += need;
5155 }
5156 }
5157 }
5158 else
5159 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5160
5161 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5162 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5163 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5164 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5165 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5166
5167 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5168 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5169 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5170 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5171
5172 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5173 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5174 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5175 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5176
5177 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5178 ;
5179
5180 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5181 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5182 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5183 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5184 changes. */
5185 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5186 {
5187 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5188 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5189 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5190 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5191 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5192 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5193 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5194 {
5195 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5196
5197 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5198 {
5199 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5200 p->pc_count = 0;
5201 if (p->count == 0)
5202 *pp = p->next;
5203 else
5204 pp = &p->next;
5205 }
5206 }
5207
5208 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5209 {
5210 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5211
5212 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5213 {
5214 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5215 *pp = p->next;
5216 else
5217 pp = &p->next;
5218 }
5219 }
5220
5221 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5222 {
5223 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5224 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5225 return FALSE;
5226 }
5227 }
5228 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5229 {
5230 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5231 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5232 dynamic. */
5233 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5234 && !h->def_regular
5235 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5236 && !(h->protected_def
5237 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5238 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5239 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5240 {
5241 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5242 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5243 return FALSE;
5244
5245 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5246 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5247 }
5248 else
5249 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5250 }
5251
5252 /* Allocate space. */
5253 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5254 {
5255 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5256 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5257 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5258 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5259 }
5260
5261 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5262 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5263 a) is dynamic, or
5264 b) is an ifunc, or
5265 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5266 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5267 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5268 if (dyn
5269 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5270 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5271 || (h->needs_plt
5272 && h->def_regular
5273 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5274 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5275 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5276 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5277 {
5278 struct plt_entry *ent;
5279 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5280 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5281
5282 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5283 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5284 {
5285 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5286
5287 if (!dyn)
5288 {
5289 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5290 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5291 else
5292 s = htab->pltlocal;
5293 }
5294
5295 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5296 {
5297 if (!doneone)
5298 {
5299 plt_offset = s->size;
5300 s->size += 4;
5301 }
5302 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5303
5304 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5305 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5306 else
5307 {
5308 s = htab->glink;
5309 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5310 {
5311 glink_offset = s->size;
5312 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5313 }
5314 if (!doneone
5315 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5316 && h->def_dynamic
5317 && !h->def_regular)
5318 {
5319 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5320 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5321 }
5322 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5323
5324 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5325 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5326 return FALSE;
5327 }
5328 }
5329 else
5330 {
5331 if (!doneone)
5332 {
5333 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5334 for the special first entry. */
5335 if (s->size == 0)
5336 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5337
5338 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5339 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5340 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5341 word available at the end. */
5342 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5343 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5344 * ((s->size
5345 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5346 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5347
5348 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5349 file, and we are not generating a shared
5350 library, then set the symbol to this location
5351 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5352 relocations, and is required to make
5353 function pointers compare as equal between
5354 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5355 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5356 && h->def_dynamic
5357 && !h->def_regular)
5358 {
5359 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5360 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5361 }
5362
5363 /* Make room for this entry. */
5364 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5365 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5366 is allocated. */
5367 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5368 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5369 / htab->plt_entry_size
5370 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5371 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5372 }
5373 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5374 }
5375
5376 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5377 if (!doneone)
5378 {
5379 if (!dyn)
5380 {
5381 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5382 {
5383 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5384 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5385 }
5386 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5387 {
5388 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5389 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5390 }
5391 }
5392 else
5393 {
5394 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5395
5396 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5397 {
5398 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5399 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5400 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5401 {
5402 if (ent->plt.offset
5403 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5404 {
5405 htab->srelplt2->size
5406 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5407 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5408 }
5409
5410 htab->srelplt2->size
5411 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5412 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5413 }
5414
5415 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5416 .got.plt. */
5417 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5418 }
5419 }
5420 doneone = TRUE;
5421 }
5422 }
5423 else
5424 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5425
5426 if (!doneone)
5427 {
5428 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5429 h->needs_plt = 0;
5430 }
5431 }
5432 else
5433 {
5434 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5435 h->needs_plt = 0;
5436 }
5437
5438 return TRUE;
5439 }
5440
5441 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5442 read-only sections. */
5443
5444 static bfd_boolean
5445 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5446 {
5447 asection *sec;
5448
5449 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5450 return TRUE;
5451
5452 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5453 if (sec != NULL)
5454 {
5455 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5456
5457 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5458 info->callbacks->minfo
5459 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5460 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5461
5462 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5463 return FALSE;
5464 }
5465 return TRUE;
5466 }
5467
5468 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5469 {
5470 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5471 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5472 1, /* CIE version. */
5473 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5474 4, /* Code alignment. */
5475 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5476 65, /* RA reg. */
5477 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5478 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5479 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5480 };
5481
5482 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5483
5484 static bfd_boolean
5485 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5486 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5487 {
5488 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5489 asection *s;
5490 bfd_boolean relocs;
5491 bfd *ibfd;
5492
5493 #ifdef DEBUG
5494 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5495 #endif
5496
5497 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5498 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5499
5500 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5501 {
5502 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5503 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5504 {
5505 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5506 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5507 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5508 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5509 }
5510 }
5511
5512 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5513 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5514 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5515 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5516
5517 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5518 relocs. */
5519 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5520 {
5521 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5522 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5523 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5524 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5525 char *lgot_masks;
5526 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5527 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5528
5529 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5530 continue;
5531
5532 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5533 {
5534 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5535
5536 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5537 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5538 p != NULL;
5539 p = p->next)
5540 {
5541 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5542 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5543 {
5544 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5545 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5546 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5547 the relocs too. */
5548 }
5549 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5550 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5551 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5552 {
5553 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5554 handled specially by the loader. */
5555 }
5556 else if (p->count != 0)
5557 {
5558 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5559 if (p->ifunc)
5560 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5561 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5562 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5563 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5564 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5565 {
5566 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5567 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5568 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5569 }
5570 }
5571 }
5572 }
5573
5574 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5575 if (!local_got)
5576 continue;
5577
5578 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5579 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5580 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5581 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5582 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5583 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5584
5585 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5586 if (*local_got > 0)
5587 {
5588 unsigned int need;
5589 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5590 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5591 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5592 if (need == 0)
5593 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5594 else
5595 {
5596 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5597 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5598 {
5599 asection *srel;
5600 bfd_boolean tprel_known = bfd_link_executable (info);
5601
5602 need = got_relocs_needed (*lgot_masks, need, tprel_known);
5603 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5604 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5605 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5606 srel->size += need;
5607 }
5608 }
5609 }
5610 else
5611 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5612
5613 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5614 continue;
5615
5616 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5617 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5618 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5619 {
5620 struct plt_entry *ent;
5621 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5622 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5623
5624 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5625 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5626 {
5627 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5628 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5629 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5630 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5631 {
5632 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5633 continue;
5634 }
5635 else
5636 s = htab->pltlocal;
5637
5638 if (!doneone)
5639 {
5640 plt_offset = s->size;
5641 s->size += 4;
5642 }
5643 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5644
5645 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5646 {
5647 s = htab->glink;
5648 glink_offset = s->size;
5649 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5650 }
5651 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5652
5653 if (!doneone)
5654 {
5655 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5656 {
5657 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5658 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5659 }
5660 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5661 {
5662 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5663 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5664 }
5665 doneone = TRUE;
5666 }
5667 }
5668 else
5669 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5670 }
5671 }
5672
5673 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5674 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5675
5676 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5677 {
5678 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5679 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5680 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5681 }
5682 else
5683 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5684
5685 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5686 {
5687 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5688
5689 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5690 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5691 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5692 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5693 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5694 {
5695 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5696 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5697 g_o_t += 4;
5698 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5699 }
5700
5701 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5702 }
5703 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5704 {
5705 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5706
5707 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5708 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5709 }
5710 if (info->emitrelocations)
5711 {
5712 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5713
5714 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5715 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5716 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5717 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5718 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5719 }
5720
5721 if (htab->glink != NULL
5722 && htab->glink->size != 0
5723 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5724 {
5725 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5726 /* Space for the branch table. */
5727 htab->glink->size
5728 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5729 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5730 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5731 ? 63 : 15);
5732 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5733
5734 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5735 {
5736 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5737 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5738 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5739 if (sh == NULL)
5740 return FALSE;
5741 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5742 {
5743 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5744 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5745 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5746 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5747 sh->def_regular = 1;
5748 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5749 sh->forced_local = 1;
5750 sh->non_elf = 0;
5751 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5752 }
5753 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5754 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5755 if (sh == NULL)
5756 return FALSE;
5757 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5758 {
5759 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5760 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5761 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5762 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5763 sh->def_regular = 1;
5764 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5765 sh->forced_local = 1;
5766 sh->non_elf = 0;
5767 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5768 }
5769 }
5770 }
5771
5772 if (htab->glink != NULL
5773 && htab->glink->size != 0
5774 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5775 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5776 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5777 {
5778 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5779 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5780 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5781 {
5782 s->size += 4;
5783 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5784 s->size += 4;
5785 }
5786 }
5787
5788 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5789 Allocate memory for them. */
5790 relocs = FALSE;
5791 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5792 {
5793 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5794
5795 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5796 continue;
5797
5798 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5799 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5800 {
5801 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5802 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5803 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5804 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5805 strip_section = FALSE;
5806 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5807 comment below. */
5808 }
5809 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5810 || s == htab->pltlocal
5811 || s == htab->glink
5812 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5813 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5814 || s == htab->sbss
5815 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5816 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5817 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5818 {
5819 /* Strip these too. */
5820 }
5821 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5822 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5823 {
5824 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5825 }
5826 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_get_section_name (htab->elf.dynobj, s),
5827 ".rela"))
5828 {
5829 if (s->size != 0)
5830 {
5831 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5832 relocs = TRUE;
5833
5834 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5835 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5836 s->reloc_count = 0;
5837 }
5838 }
5839 else
5840 {
5841 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5842 continue;
5843 }
5844
5845 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5846 {
5847 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5848 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5849 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5850 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5851 before the linker maps input sections to output
5852 sections. The linker does that before
5853 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5854 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5855 into these sections. */
5856 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5857 continue;
5858 }
5859
5860 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5861 continue;
5862
5863 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5864 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5865 if (s->contents == NULL)
5866 return FALSE;
5867 }
5868
5869 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5870 {
5871 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5872 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5873 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5874 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5875 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5876 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5877 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5878
5879 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5880 {
5881 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5882 return FALSE;
5883 }
5884
5885 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5886 {
5887 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5888 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5889 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5890 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5891 return FALSE;
5892 }
5893
5894 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5895 && htab->glink != NULL
5896 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5897 {
5898 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5899 return FALSE;
5900 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5901 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5902 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5903 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5904 return FALSE;
5905 }
5906
5907 if (relocs)
5908 {
5909 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5910 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5911 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5912 return FALSE;
5913 }
5914
5915 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5916 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5917 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5918 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5919 info);
5920
5921 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5922 {
5923 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5924 return FALSE;
5925 }
5926 if (htab->is_vxworks
5927 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5928 return FALSE;
5929 }
5930 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5931
5932 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5933 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5934 {
5935 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5936 bfd_vma val;
5937
5938 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5939 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5940 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5941 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5942 /* FDE length. */
5943 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5944 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5945 p += 4;
5946 /* CIE pointer. */
5947 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5948 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5949 p += 4;
5950 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5951 p += 4;
5952 /* .glink size. */
5953 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5954 p += 4;
5955 /* Augmentation. */
5956 p += 1;
5957
5958 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5959 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5960 {
5961 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5962 if (adv < 64)
5963 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5964 else if (adv < 256)
5965 {
5966 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5967 *p++ = adv;
5968 }
5969 else if (adv < 65536)
5970 {
5971 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5972 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5973 p += 2;
5974 }
5975 else
5976 {
5977 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5978 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5979 p += 4;
5980 }
5981 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5982 *p++ = 65;
5983 p++;
5984 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5985 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5986 *p++ = 65;
5987 }
5988 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5989 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5990 }
5991
5992 return TRUE;
5993 }
5994
5995 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5996 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5997
5998 static void
5999 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
6000 {
6001 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
6002
6003 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6004 {
6005 asection *s;
6006
6007 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6008 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6009 {
6010 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6011 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6012 {
6013 sda->def_regular = 0;
6014 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6015 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6016 sda->forced_local = 0;
6017 }
6018 }
6019 }
6020 }
6021
6022 void
6023 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6024 {
6025 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6026
6027 if (htab != NULL)
6028 {
6029 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6030 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6031 }
6032 }
6033
6034
6035 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6036
6037 static bfd_boolean
6038 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6039 {
6040 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6041 && !h->def_regular
6042 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6043 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6044 return FALSE;
6045
6046 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6047 }
6048 \f
6049 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6050
6051 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6052 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6053 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6054 {
6055 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6056 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6057 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6058 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6059 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6060 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6061 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6062 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6063 };
6064
6065 static const int stub_entry[] =
6066 {
6067 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6068 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6069 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6070 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6071 };
6072
6073 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6074 {
6075 unsigned int workaround_size;
6076 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6077 };
6078
6079 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6080 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6081 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6082 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6083
6084 static bfd_boolean
6085 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6086 asection *isec,
6087 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6088 bfd_boolean *again)
6089 {
6090 struct one_branch_fixup
6091 {
6092 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6093 asection *tsec;
6094 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6095 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6096 bfd_vma toff;
6097 bfd_vma trampoff;
6098 };
6099
6100 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6101 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6102 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6103 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6104 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6105 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6106 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6107 unsigned changes = 0;
6108 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6109 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6110 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6111 asection *got2;
6112 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6113
6114 *again = FALSE;
6115
6116 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6117 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6118 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6119 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6120 || isec->size < 4)
6121 return TRUE;
6122
6123 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6124 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6125 anyway. */
6126 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6127 return TRUE;
6128
6129 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6130 if (htab == NULL)
6131 return TRUE;
6132
6133 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6134 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6135 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6136 trampbase = isec->size;
6137
6138 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6139 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6140 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6141
6142 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6143 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6144 {
6145 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6146 {
6147 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6148 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6149 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6150 return FALSE;
6151 }
6152 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6153 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6154 }
6155
6156 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6157 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6158 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6159 trampoff = trampbase;
6160 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6161 trampoff += 4;
6162
6163 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6164 picfixup_size = 0;
6165 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6166 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6167 {
6168 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6169 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6170 {
6171 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6172 link_info->keep_memory);
6173 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6174 goto error_return;
6175 }
6176
6177 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6178
6179 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6180 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6181 {
6182 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6183 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6184 asection *tsec;
6185 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6186 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6187 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6188 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6189 unsigned long t0;
6190 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6191 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6192 struct plt_entry **plist;
6193 unsigned char sym_type;
6194
6195 switch (r_type)
6196 {
6197 case R_PPC_REL24:
6198 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6199 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6200 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6201 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6202 break;
6203
6204 case R_PPC_REL14:
6205 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6206 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6207 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6208 break;
6209
6210 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6211 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6212 break;
6213 continue;
6214
6215 default:
6216 continue;
6217 }
6218
6219 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6220 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6221 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6222 goto error_return;
6223
6224 if (isym != NULL)
6225 {
6226 if (tsec != NULL)
6227 ;
6228 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6229 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6230 else
6231 continue;
6232
6233 toff = isym->st_value;
6234 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6235 }
6236 else
6237 {
6238 if (tsec != NULL)
6239 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6240 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6241 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6242 {
6243 unsigned long indx;
6244
6245 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6246 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6247 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6248 }
6249 else
6250 continue;
6251
6252 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6253 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6254 branch stub in that case. */
6255 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6256 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6257 && irel != internal_relocs)
6258 {
6259 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6260 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6261 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6262
6263 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6264 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6265 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6266 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6267 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6268 {
6269 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6270
6271 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6272 {
6273 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6274 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6275 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6276 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6277 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6278 }
6279 }
6280 else
6281 {
6282 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6283 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6284
6285 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6286 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6287 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6288
6289 tls_mask
6290 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6291 }
6292
6293 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6294 optimised away. */
6295 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6296 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6297 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6298 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6299 continue;
6300 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6301 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6302 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6303 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6304 continue;
6305 }
6306
6307 sym_type = h->type;
6308 }
6309
6310 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6311 {
6312 if (h != NULL
6313 && !h->def_regular
6314 && h->protected_def
6315 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6316 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6317 picfixup_size += 12;
6318 continue;
6319 }
6320
6321 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6322 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6323 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6324 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6325 plist = NULL;
6326 if (h != NULL)
6327 {
6328 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6329 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6330 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6331 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6332 }
6333 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6334 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6335 {
6336 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6337 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6338 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6339 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6340 }
6341 if (plist != NULL)
6342 {
6343 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6344 struct plt_entry *ent;
6345
6346 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6347 addend = irel->r_addend;
6348 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6349 if (ent != NULL)
6350 {
6351 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6352 || h == NULL
6353 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6354 || h->dynindx == -1)
6355 {
6356 tsec = htab->glink;
6357 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6358 }
6359 else
6360 {
6361 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6362 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6363 }
6364 }
6365 }
6366
6367 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6368 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6369 branch overflow. */
6370 if (tsec == isec)
6371 continue;
6372
6373 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6374 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6375 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6376 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6377 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6378 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6379 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6380 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6381 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6382 continue;
6383
6384 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6385 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6386 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6387 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6388 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6389 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6390 {
6391 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6392 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6393 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6394 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6395 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6396
6397 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6398 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6399 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6400 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6401 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6402 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6403 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6404 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6405 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6406 location of interest is just "sym". */
6407 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6408 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6409 toff += irel->r_addend;
6410
6411 toff
6412 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6413 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6414 toff);
6415
6416 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6417 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6418 toff += irel->r_addend;
6419 }
6420 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6421 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6422 toff += irel->r_addend;
6423
6424 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6425 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6426 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6427 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6428 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6429 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6430 continue;
6431
6432 roff = irel->r_offset;
6433
6434 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6435 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6436 fixup can be created at final link.
6437 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6438 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6439 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6440 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6441 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6442 continue;
6443
6444 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6445 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6446 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6447 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6448 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6449 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6450 {
6451 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6452
6453 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6454 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6455 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6456 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6457 continue;
6458 }
6459
6460 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6461 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6462 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6463 break;
6464
6465 if (f == NULL)
6466 {
6467 size_t size;
6468 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6469
6470 val = trampoff - roff;
6471 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6472 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6473 one. We'll report an error later. */
6474 continue;
6475
6476 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6477 {
6478 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6479 insn_offset = 12;
6480 }
6481 else
6482 {
6483 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6484 insn_offset = 0;
6485 }
6486 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6487 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6488 || tsec == htab->glink)
6489 {
6490 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6491 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6492 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6493 }
6494
6495 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6496 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6497 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6498 stub_rtype);
6499 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6500 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6501 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6502 irel->r_addend = 0;
6503
6504 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6505 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6506 f->next = branch_fixups;
6507 f->tsec = tsec;
6508 f->toff = toff;
6509 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6510 branch_fixups = f;
6511
6512 trampoff += size;
6513 changes++;
6514 }
6515 else
6516 {
6517 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6518 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6519 continue;
6520
6521 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6522 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6523 }
6524
6525 /* Get the section contents. */
6526 if (contents == NULL)
6527 {
6528 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6529 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6530 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6531 /* Go get them off disk. */
6532 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6533 goto error_return;
6534 }
6535
6536 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6537 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6538 switch (r_type)
6539 {
6540 case R_PPC_REL24:
6541 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6542 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6543 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6544 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6545 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6546 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6547 break;
6548
6549 case R_PPC_REL14:
6550 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6551 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6552 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6553 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6554 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6555 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6556 break;
6557 }
6558 }
6559
6560 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6561 {
6562 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6563 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6564 free (f);
6565 }
6566 }
6567
6568 workaround_change = FALSE;
6569 newsize = trampoff;
6570 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6571 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6572 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6573 {
6574 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6575 unsigned int crossings;
6576 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6577
6578 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6579 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6580 addr &= -pagesize;
6581 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6582 if (crossings != 0)
6583 {
6584 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6585 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6586 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6587 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6588 newsize += crossings * 16;
6589 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6590 {
6591 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6592 workaround_change = TRUE;
6593 }
6594 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6595 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6596 }
6597 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6598 }
6599
6600 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6601 {
6602 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6603 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6604 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6605 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6606 }
6607
6608 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6609 isec->size = newsize;
6610
6611 if (isymbuf != NULL
6612 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6613 {
6614 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6615 free (isymbuf);
6616 else
6617 {
6618 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6619 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6620 }
6621 }
6622
6623 if (contents != NULL
6624 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6625 {
6626 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6627 free (contents);
6628 else
6629 {
6630 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6631 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6632 }
6633 }
6634
6635 changes += picfixup_size;
6636 if (changes != 0)
6637 {
6638 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6639 information for the trampolines. */
6640 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6641 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6642 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6643 unsigned ix;
6644
6645 if (!new_relocs)
6646 goto error_return;
6647 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6648 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6649 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6650 {
6651 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6652
6653 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6654 }
6655 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6656 free (internal_relocs);
6657 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6658 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6659 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6660 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6661 }
6662 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6663 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6664 free (internal_relocs);
6665
6666 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6667 return TRUE;
6668
6669 error_return:
6670 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6671 {
6672 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6673 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6674 free (f);
6675 }
6676 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6677 free (isymbuf);
6678 if (contents != NULL
6679 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6680 free (contents);
6681 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6682 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6683 free (internal_relocs);
6684 return FALSE;
6685 }
6686 \f
6687 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6688 discarded sections. */
6689
6690 static unsigned int
6691 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6692 {
6693 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6694 return 0;
6695
6696 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6697 return 0;
6698
6699 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6700 }
6701 \f
6702 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6703
6704 static bfd_vma
6705 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6706 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6707 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6708 bfd_vma relocation,
6709 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6710 {
6711 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6712
6713 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6714
6715 if (h != NULL)
6716 {
6717 /* Handle global symbol. */
6718 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6719
6720 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6721 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6722 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6723 }
6724 else
6725 {
6726 /* Handle local symbol. */
6727 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6728
6729 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6730 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6731 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6732 }
6733
6734 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6735 rel->r_addend,
6736 lsect);
6737 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6738
6739 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6740 as a "written" flag. */
6741 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6742 {
6743 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6744 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6745 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6746 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6747 }
6748
6749 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6750 + lsect->section->output_offset
6751 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6752 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6753
6754 #ifdef DEBUG
6755 fprintf (stderr,
6756 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6757 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6758 #endif
6759
6760 return relocation;
6761 }
6762
6763 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6764 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6765 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6766
6767 static void
6768 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6769 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6770 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6771 {
6772 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6773 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6774 bfd_vma plt;
6775 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6776
6777 if (h != NULL
6778 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6779 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6780 {
6781 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6782 p += 4;
6783 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6784 p += 4;
6785 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6786 p += 4;
6787 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6788 p += 4;
6789 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6790 p += 4;
6791 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6792 p += 4;
6793 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6794 p += 4;
6795 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6796 p += 4;
6797 }
6798
6799 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6800 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6801 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6802
6803 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6804 {
6805 bfd_vma got = 0;
6806
6807 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6808 got = (ent->addend
6809 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6810 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6811 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6812 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6813
6814 plt -= got;
6815
6816 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6817 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6818 else
6819 {
6820 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6821 p += 4;
6822 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6823 }
6824 }
6825 else
6826 {
6827 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6828 p += 4;
6829 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6830 }
6831 p += 4;
6832 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6833 p += 4;
6834 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6835 p += 4;
6836 while (p < end)
6837 {
6838 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6839 p += 4;
6840 }
6841 }
6842
6843 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6844
6845 static bfd_boolean
6846 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6847 {
6848 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6849 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6850 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6851 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6852 }
6853
6854 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6855 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6856 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6857
6858 unsigned int
6859 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6860 {
6861 unsigned int rtra;
6862
6863 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6864 return 0;
6865
6866 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6867 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6868 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6869 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6870 else
6871 return 0;
6872
6873 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6874 /* add -> addi. */
6875 insn = 14 << 26;
6876 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6877 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6878 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6879 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6880 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6881 insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6882 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6883 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6884 insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6885 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6886 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6887 insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6888 else
6889 return 0;
6890 insn |= rtra;
6891 return insn;
6892 }
6893
6894 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6895 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6896 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6897
6898 unsigned int
6899 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6900 {
6901 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6902 && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6903 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6904 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6905 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6906 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6907 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6908 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6909 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6910 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6911 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6912 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6913 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6914 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6915 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6916 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6917 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6918 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6919 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6920 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6921 {
6922 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6923 }
6924 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6925 && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6926 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6927 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6928 {
6929 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6930 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6931 if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6932 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6933 }
6934 else
6935 insn = 0;
6936 return insn;
6937 }
6938
6939 static bfd_boolean
6940 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6941 {
6942 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6943 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6944 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6945 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6946 }
6947
6948 static bfd_boolean
6949 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6950 {
6951 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6952 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6953 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6954 }
6955
6956 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6957 to handle the relocations for a section.
6958
6959 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6960 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6961 zero.
6962
6963 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6964 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6965 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6966 necessary.
6967
6968 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6969 address or the reloc symbol index.
6970
6971 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6972
6973 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6974 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6975
6976 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6977 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6978
6979 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6980 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6981 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6982 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6983 accordingly. */
6984
6985 static bfd_boolean
6986 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6987 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6988 bfd *input_bfd,
6989 asection *input_section,
6990 bfd_byte *contents,
6991 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6992 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6993 asection **local_sections)
6994 {
6995 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6996 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6997 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6998 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6999 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
7000 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7001 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
7002 asection *got2;
7003 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7004 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
7005 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7006 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
7007 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7008 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7009
7010 #ifdef DEBUG
7011 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7012 "%ld relocations%s",
7013 input_bfd, input_section,
7014 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7015 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7016 #endif
7017
7018 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7019 {
7020 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7021 return FALSE;
7022 }
7023
7024 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7025
7026 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7027 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7028 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7029
7030 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7031 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7032 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7033 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7034 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7035 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7036 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7037 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7038 ".tls_vars"));
7039 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7040 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7041 rel = wrel = relocs;
7042 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7043 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7044 {
7045 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7046 bfd_vma addend;
7047 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7048 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7049 asection *sec;
7050 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7051 const char *sym_name;
7052 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7053 unsigned long r_symndx;
7054 bfd_vma relocation;
7055 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7056 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7057 bfd_boolean warned;
7058 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7059 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7060 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7061
7062 again:
7063 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7064 sym = NULL;
7065 sec = NULL;
7066 h = NULL;
7067 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7068 warned = FALSE;
7069 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7070
7071 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7072 {
7073 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7074 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7075 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7076
7077 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7078 }
7079 else
7080 {
7081 bfd_boolean ignored;
7082
7083 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7084 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7085 h, sec, relocation,
7086 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7087
7088 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7089 }
7090
7091 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7092 {
7093 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7094 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7095 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7096 howto = NULL;
7097 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7098 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7099
7100 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7101 contents, rel->r_offset);
7102 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7103 wrel->r_info = 0;
7104 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7105
7106 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7107 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7108 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7109 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7110 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7111 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7112 wrel--;
7113
7114 continue;
7115 }
7116
7117 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7118 {
7119 if (got2 != NULL
7120 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7121 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7122 {
7123 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7124 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7125 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7126 }
7127 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7128 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7129 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7130 goto copy_reloc;
7131 }
7132
7133 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7134 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7135 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7136 for the final instruction stream. */
7137 tls_mask = 0;
7138 tls_gd = 0;
7139 if (h != NULL)
7140 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7141 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7142 {
7143 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7144 char *lgot_masks;
7145 local_plt
7146 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7147 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7148 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7149 }
7150
7151 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7152 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7153 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7154 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7155 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7156 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7157 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7158 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7159 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7160 abort ();
7161 switch (r_type)
7162 {
7163 default:
7164 break;
7165
7166 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7167 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7168 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7169 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7170 {
7171 bfd_vma insn;
7172
7173 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7174 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7175 insn &= 31 << 21;
7176 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7177 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7178 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7179 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7180 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7181 }
7182 break;
7183
7184 case R_PPC_TLS:
7185 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7186 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7187 {
7188 bfd_vma insn;
7189
7190 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7191 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7192 if (insn == 0)
7193 abort ();
7194 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7195 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7196 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7197
7198 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7199 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7200 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7201 }
7202 break;
7203
7204 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7205 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7206 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7207 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7208 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7209 break;
7210
7211 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7212 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7213 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7214 {
7215 tls_gdld_hi:
7216 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7217 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7218 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7219 else
7220 {
7221 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7222 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7223 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7224 }
7225 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7226 }
7227 break;
7228
7229 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7230 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7231 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7232 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7233 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7234 break;
7235
7236 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7237 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7238 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7239 {
7240 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7241 bfd_vma offset;
7242
7243 tls_ldgd_opt:
7244 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7245 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7246 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7247 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7248 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7249 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7250 if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
7251 && rel + 1 < relend
7252 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7253 htab->tls_get_addr))
7254 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7255 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7256 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7257 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7258 intervening code. */
7259 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7260 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7261 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7262 {
7263 /* IE */
7264 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7265 insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7266 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7267 {
7268 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7269 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7270 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7271 }
7272 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7273 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7274 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7275 }
7276 else
7277 {
7278 /* LE */
7279 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7280 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7281 if (tls_gd == 0)
7282 {
7283 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7284 for (r_symndx = 0;
7285 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7286 r_symndx++)
7287 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7288 break;
7289 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7290 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7291 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7292 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7293 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7294 + sec->output_offset
7295 + sec->output_section->vma);
7296 }
7297 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7298 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7299 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7300 {
7301 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7302 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7303 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7304 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7305 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7306 }
7307 }
7308 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7309 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7310 if (tls_gd == 0)
7311 {
7312 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7313 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7314 goto again;
7315 }
7316 }
7317 break;
7318
7319 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7320 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7321 && rel + 1 < relend)
7322 {
7323 unsigned int insn2;
7324 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7325
7326 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7327 {
7328 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7329 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7330 break;
7331 }
7332
7333 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7334 {
7335 /* IE */
7336 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7337 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7338 }
7339 else
7340 {
7341 /* LE */
7342 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7343 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7344 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7345 }
7346 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7347 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7348 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7349 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7350 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7351 }
7352 break;
7353
7354 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7355 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7356 && rel + 1 < relend)
7357 {
7358 unsigned int insn2;
7359
7360 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7361 {
7362 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7363 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7364 break;
7365 }
7366
7367 for (r_symndx = 0;
7368 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7369 r_symndx++)
7370 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7371 break;
7372 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7373 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7374 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7375 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7376 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7377 + sec->output_offset
7378 + sec->output_section->vma);
7379
7380 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7381 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7382 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7383 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7384 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7385 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7386 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7387 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7388 goto again;
7389 }
7390 break;
7391 }
7392
7393 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7394 branch_bit = 0;
7395 switch (r_type)
7396 {
7397 default:
7398 break;
7399
7400 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7401 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7402 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7403 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7404 /* Fall through. */
7405
7406 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7407 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7408 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7409 {
7410 unsigned int insn;
7411
7412 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7413 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7414 insn |= branch_bit;
7415
7416 from = (rel->r_offset
7417 + input_section->output_offset
7418 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7419
7420 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7421 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7422 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7423
7424 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7425 }
7426 break;
7427
7428 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7429 {
7430 unsigned int insn;
7431
7432 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7433 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7434 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7435 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7436 {
7437 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7438 {
7439 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7440 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7441 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7442 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7443 }
7444 }
7445 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7446 info->callbacks->einfo
7447 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7448 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7449 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7450 }
7451 break;
7452 }
7453
7454 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7455 && h != NULL
7456 && !h->def_regular
7457 && h->protected_def
7458 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7459 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7460 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7461 {
7462 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7463 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7464 unsigned int insn;
7465
7466 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7467 {
7468 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7469 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7470 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7471 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7472 {
7473 bfd_byte *p;
7474 bfd_vma off;
7475 bfd_vma got_addr;
7476
7477 p = (contents + input_section->size
7478 - relax_info->workaround_size
7479 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7480 + picfixup_size);
7481 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7482 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7483 info->callbacks->einfo
7484 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7485 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7486
7487 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7488 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7489 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7490 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7491 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7492 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7493 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7494 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7495 insn &= ~0xffff;
7496 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7497 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7498
7499 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7500 insn &= ~0xffff;
7501 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7502 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7503 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7504 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7505
7506 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7507 picfixup_size += 12;
7508
7509 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7510 output is reasonable. */
7511 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7512 wrel++, rel++;
7513 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7514 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7515 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7516
7517 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7518 dynamic reloc. */
7519 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7520 }
7521 else
7522 _bfd_error_handler
7523 /* xgettext:c-format */
7524 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7525 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7526 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7527 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7528 }
7529 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7530 {
7531 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7532 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7533 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7534 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7535 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7536 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7537 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7538 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7539 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7540 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7541 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7542 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7543 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7544 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7545 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7546 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7547 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7548 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7549 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7550 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7551 {
7552 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7553 relocation = 0;
7554 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7555 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7556 }
7557 else
7558 _bfd_error_handler
7559 /* xgettext:c-format */
7560 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7561 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7562 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7563 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7564 }
7565 }
7566
7567 ifunc = NULL;
7568 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7569 {
7570 struct plt_entry *ent;
7571
7572 if (h != NULL)
7573 {
7574 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7575 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7576 }
7577 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7578 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7579 {
7580 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7581
7582 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7583 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7584 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7585 }
7586
7587 ent = NULL;
7588 if (ifunc != NULL
7589 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7590 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7591 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7592 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7593 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7594 {
7595 addend = 0;
7596 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7597 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7598 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7599 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7600 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7601 addend = rel->r_addend;
7602 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7603 }
7604 if (ent != NULL)
7605 {
7606 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7607 && ent->sec != got2
7608 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7609 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7610 || h == NULL
7611 || h->dynindx == -1))
7612 {
7613 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7614 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7615 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7616 apparently are using code compiled with
7617 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7618 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7619 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7620 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7621 into .got2). */
7622 info->callbacks->einfo
7623 /* xgettext:c-format */
7624 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7625 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7626 }
7627
7628 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7629 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7630 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7631 || h == NULL
7632 || h->dynindx == -1)
7633 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7634 + htab->glink->output_offset
7635 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7636 else
7637 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7638 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7639 + ent->plt.offset);
7640 }
7641 }
7642
7643 addend = rel->r_addend;
7644 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7645 howto = NULL;
7646 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7647 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7648
7649 switch (r_type)
7650 {
7651 default:
7652 break;
7653
7654 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7655 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7656 {
7657 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7658 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7659 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7660 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7661 /* xgettext:c-format */
7662 info->callbacks->minfo
7663 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7664 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7665 else
7666 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7667 }
7668 break;
7669
7670 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7671 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7672 {
7673 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7674 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7675 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7676 insn |= 2 << 16;
7677 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7678 }
7679 break;
7680 }
7681
7682 tls_type = 0;
7683 switch (r_type)
7684 {
7685 default:
7686 /* xgettext:c-format */
7687 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7688 input_bfd, howto->name);
7689
7690 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7691 ret = FALSE;
7692 goto copy_reloc;
7693
7694 case R_PPC_NONE:
7695 case R_PPC_TLS:
7696 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7697 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7698 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7699 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7700 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7701 goto copy_reloc;
7702
7703 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7704 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7705 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7706 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7707 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7708 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7709 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7710 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7711 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7712 goto dogot;
7713
7714 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7715 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7716 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7717 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7718 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7719 goto dogot;
7720
7721 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7722 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7723 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7724 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7725 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7726 goto dogot;
7727
7728 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7729 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7730 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7731 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7732 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7733 goto dogot;
7734
7735 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7736 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7737 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7738 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7739 tls_mask = 0;
7740 dogot:
7741 {
7742 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7743 offset table. */
7744 bfd_vma off;
7745 bfd_vma *offp;
7746 unsigned long indx;
7747
7748 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7749 abort ();
7750
7751 indx = 0;
7752 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7753 && (h == NULL
7754 || !h->def_dynamic))
7755 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7756 else if (h != NULL)
7757 {
7758 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7759 || h->dynindx == -1
7760 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7761 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7762 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7763 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7764 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7765 because of a version file. */
7766 ;
7767 else
7768 {
7769 indx = h->dynindx;
7770 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7771 }
7772 offp = &h->got.offset;
7773 }
7774 else
7775 {
7776 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7777 abort ();
7778 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7779 }
7780
7781 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7782 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7783 processed this entry. */
7784 off = *offp;
7785 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7786 off &= ~1;
7787 else
7788 {
7789 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7790 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7791 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7792 : 0);
7793
7794 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7795 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7796 else if (h == NULL
7797 || !h->def_dynamic)
7798 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7799
7800 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7801 Initialize them all. */
7802 do
7803 {
7804 int tls_ty = 0;
7805
7806 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7807 {
7808 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7809 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7810 }
7811 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7812 {
7813 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7814 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7815 }
7816 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7817 {
7818 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7819 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7820 }
7821 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7822 {
7823 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7824 tls_m = 0;
7825 }
7826
7827 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7828 if (indx != 0
7829 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7830 && (h == NULL
7831 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)
7832 || offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7833 && !(tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
7834 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7835 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7836 {
7837 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7838 bfd_byte * loc;
7839
7840 if (ifunc != NULL)
7841 {
7842 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7843 if (indx == 0)
7844 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7845 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7846 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7847 }
7848 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7849 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7850 + off);
7851 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7852 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7853 {
7854 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7855 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7856 {
7857 loc = rsec->contents;
7858 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7859 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7860 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7861 &outrel, loc);
7862 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7863 outrel.r_info
7864 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7865 }
7866 }
7867 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7868 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7869 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7870 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7871 else if (indx != 0)
7872 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7873 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7874 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7875 else
7876 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7877 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7878 {
7879 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7880 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7881 {
7882 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7883 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7884 else
7885 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7886 }
7887 }
7888 loc = rsec->contents;
7889 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7890 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7891 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7892 }
7893
7894 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7895 emitting a reloc. */
7896 else
7897 {
7898 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7899
7900 if (tls_ty != 0)
7901 {
7902 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7903 value = 0;
7904 else
7905 {
7906 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7907 value = 0;
7908 else
7909 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7910 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7911 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7912 }
7913
7914 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7915 {
7916 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7917 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7918 value = 1;
7919 }
7920 }
7921 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7922 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7923 }
7924
7925 off += 4;
7926 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7927 off += 4;
7928 }
7929 while (tls_m != 0);
7930
7931 off = *offp;
7932 *offp = off | 1;
7933 }
7934
7935 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7936 abort ();
7937
7938 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7939 {
7940 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7941 {
7942 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7943 && !(h == NULL
7944 || !h->def_dynamic))
7945 off += 8;
7946 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7947 {
7948 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7949 off += 8;
7950 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7951 {
7952 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7953 off += 4;
7954 }
7955 }
7956 }
7957 }
7958
7959 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7960 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7961 goto copy_reloc;
7962
7963 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7964 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7965 + off
7966 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7967
7968 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7969 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7970 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7971 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7972 if (addend != 0)
7973 info->callbacks->einfo
7974 /* xgettext:c-format */
7975 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7976 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7977 howto->name,
7978 sym_name);
7979 }
7980 break;
7981
7982 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7983 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7984 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7985 at a symbol not in this object. */
7986 if (unresolved_reloc)
7987 {
7988 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7989 h->root.root.string,
7990 input_bfd,
7991 input_section,
7992 rel->r_offset,
7993 TRUE);
7994 goto copy_reloc;
7995 }
7996 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7997 {
7998 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7999 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
8000 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
8001 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
8002 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
8003 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
8004 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
8005 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
8006 /* xgettext:c-format */
8007 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
8008 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8009 h->root.root.string);
8010 }
8011 break;
8012
8013 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8014 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8015 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8016 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8017 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8018 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8019 break;
8020
8021 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8022 object. */
8023 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8024 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8025 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8026 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8027 if (h != NULL
8028 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8029 && h->dynindx == -1)
8030 {
8031 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8032 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8033 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8034 defined before using them. */
8035 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8036 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8037 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8038 if (insn != 0)
8039 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8040 break;
8041 }
8042 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8043 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8044 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8045 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8046 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8047 goto dodyn;
8048
8049 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8050 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8051 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8052 goto dodyn;
8053
8054 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8055 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8056 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8057 goto dodyn;
8058
8059 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8060 relocation = 1;
8061 addend = 0;
8062 goto dodyn;
8063
8064 case R_PPC_REL16:
8065 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8066 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8067 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8068 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8069 break;
8070
8071 case R_PPC_REL32:
8072 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8073 break;
8074 /* fall through */
8075
8076 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8077 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8078 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8079 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8080 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8081 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8082 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8083 goto dodyn;
8084
8085 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8086 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8087 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8088 case R_PPC_REL24:
8089 case R_PPC_REL14:
8090 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8091 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8092 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8093 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8094 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8095 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8096 break;
8097 /* fall through */
8098
8099 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8100 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8101 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8102 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8103 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8104 break;
8105 /* fall through */
8106
8107 dodyn:
8108 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8109 || is_vxworks_tls)
8110 break;
8111
8112 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8113 ? ((h == NULL
8114 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8115 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8116 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8117 : (h != NULL
8118 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8119 {
8120 int skip;
8121 bfd_byte *loc;
8122 asection *sreloc;
8123 long indx = 0;
8124
8125 #ifdef DEBUG
8126 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8127 "create relocation for %s\n",
8128 (h && h->root.root.string
8129 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8130 #endif
8131
8132 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8133 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8134 time. */
8135 skip = 0;
8136 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8137 input_section,
8138 rel->r_offset);
8139 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8140 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8141 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8142 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8143 + input_section->output_offset);
8144
8145 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8146 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8147 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8148 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8149 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8150 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8151 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8152
8153 if (skip)
8154 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8155 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8156 {
8157 indx = h->dynindx;
8158 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8159 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8160 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8161 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8162 }
8163 else
8164 {
8165 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8166
8167 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8168 {
8169 if (ifunc != NULL)
8170 {
8171 /* If we get here when building a static
8172 executable, then the libc startup function
8173 responsible for applying indirect function
8174 relocations is going to complain about
8175 the reloc type.
8176 If we get here when building a dynamic
8177 executable, it will be because we have
8178 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8179 will set the text segment writable and
8180 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8181 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8182 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8183 info->callbacks->einfo
8184 /* xgettext:c-format */
8185 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8186 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8187 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8188 howto->name,
8189 sym_name);
8190 ret = FALSE;
8191 }
8192 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8193 ;
8194 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8195 {
8196 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8197 ret = FALSE;
8198 }
8199 else
8200 {
8201 asection *osec;
8202
8203 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8204 against a section symbol. It would be
8205 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8206 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8207 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8208 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8209 osec = sec->output_section;
8210 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8211 {
8212 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8213 indx = 0;
8214 }
8215 else
8216 {
8217 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8218 if (indx == 0)
8219 {
8220 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8221 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8222 }
8223 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8224 }
8225
8226 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8227 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8228 addend for them. */
8229 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8230 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8231 }
8232
8233 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8234 }
8235 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8236 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8237 else
8238 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8239 }
8240
8241 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8242 if (ifunc)
8243 {
8244 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8245 if (indx == 0)
8246 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8247 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8248 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8249 }
8250 if (sreloc == NULL)
8251 return FALSE;
8252
8253 loc = sreloc->contents;
8254 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8255 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8256
8257 if (skip == -1)
8258 goto copy_reloc;
8259
8260 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8261 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8262 if (!skip)
8263 {
8264 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8265 addend = 0;
8266 break;
8267 }
8268 }
8269 break;
8270
8271 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8272 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8273 if (h != NULL)
8274 {
8275 struct plt_entry *ent;
8276 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8277
8278 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8279 {
8280 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8281 got2_addend = addend;
8282 addend = 0;
8283 }
8284 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8285 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8286 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8287 + htab->glink->output_offset
8288 + ent->glink_offset);
8289 else
8290 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8291 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8292 + ent->plt.offset);
8293 }
8294 /* Fall through. */
8295
8296 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8297 {
8298 const int *stub;
8299 size_t size;
8300 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8301 unsigned int insn;
8302
8303 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8304 {
8305 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8306 + input_section->output_offset
8307 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8308 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8309 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8310 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8311 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8312 stub += 3;
8313 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8314 }
8315 else
8316 {
8317 stub = stub_entry;
8318 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8319 }
8320
8321 relocation += addend;
8322 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8323 relocation = 0;
8324
8325 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8326 insn = *stub++;
8327 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8328 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8329 insn_offset += 4;
8330
8331 insn = *stub++;
8332 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8333 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8334 insn_offset += 4;
8335 size -= 2;
8336
8337 while (size != 0)
8338 {
8339 insn = *stub++;
8340 --size;
8341 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8342 insn_offset += 4;
8343 }
8344
8345 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8346 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8347 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8348 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8349 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8350 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8351 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8352 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8353 wrel++, rel++;
8354 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8355 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8356 }
8357 continue;
8358
8359 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8360 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8361 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8362 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8363 {
8364 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8365 break;
8366 }
8367 relocation
8368 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8369 h, relocation, rel);
8370 addend = 0;
8371 break;
8372
8373 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8374 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8375 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8376 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8377 {
8378 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8379 break;
8380 }
8381 relocation
8382 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8383 h, relocation, rel);
8384 addend = 0;
8385 break;
8386
8387 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8388 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8389 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8390 AIX .toc section. */
8391 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8392 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8393 {
8394 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8395 break;
8396 }
8397 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8398 ".got") == 0
8399 || strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8400 ".cgot") == 0);
8401
8402 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8403 break;
8404
8405 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8406 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8407 {
8408 struct plt_entry *ent;
8409
8410 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8411 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8412 if (ent == NULL
8413 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8414 {
8415 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8416 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8417 using -Bsymbolic. */
8418 }
8419 else
8420 {
8421 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8422 procedure linkage table. */
8423 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8424 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8425 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8426 + htab->glink->output_offset
8427 + ent->glink_offset);
8428 else
8429 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8430 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8431 + ent->plt.offset);
8432 }
8433 }
8434
8435 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8436 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8437 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8438 addend = 0;
8439 break;
8440
8441 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8442 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8443 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8444 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8445 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8446 plt_list = NULL;
8447 if (h != NULL)
8448 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8449 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8450 plt_list = ifunc;
8451 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8452 {
8453 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8454 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8455 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8456 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8457 }
8458 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8459 if (plt_list != NULL)
8460 {
8461 struct plt_entry *ent;
8462
8463 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8464 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8465 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8466 {
8467 asection *plt;
8468
8469 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8470 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8471 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8472 || h == NULL
8473 || h->dynindx == -1)
8474 {
8475 if (ifunc != NULL)
8476 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8477 else
8478 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8479 }
8480 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8481 + plt->output_offset
8482 + ent->plt.offset);
8483 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8484 {
8485 bfd_vma got = 0;
8486
8487 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8488 got = (ent->addend
8489 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8490 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8491 else
8492 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8493 relocation -= got;
8494 }
8495 }
8496 }
8497 addend = 0;
8498 break;
8499
8500 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8501 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8502 {
8503 const char *name;
8504 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8505
8506 if (sec == NULL
8507 || sec->output_section == NULL
8508 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8509 {
8510 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8511 break;
8512 }
8513 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8514
8515 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8516 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8517 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8518 {
8519 _bfd_error_handler
8520 /* xgettext:c-format */
8521 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8522 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8523 input_bfd,
8524 sym_name,
8525 howto->name,
8526 name);
8527 }
8528 }
8529 break;
8530
8531 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8532 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8533 {
8534 const char *name;
8535 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8536
8537 if (sec == NULL
8538 || sec->output_section == NULL
8539 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8540 {
8541 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8542 break;
8543 }
8544 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8545
8546 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8547 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8548 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8549 {
8550 _bfd_error_handler
8551 /* xgettext:c-format */
8552 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8553 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8554 input_bfd,
8555 sym_name,
8556 howto->name,
8557 name);
8558 }
8559 }
8560 break;
8561
8562 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8563 relocation = relocation + addend;
8564 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8565 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8566 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8567 goto copy_reloc;
8568
8569 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8570 relocation = relocation + addend;
8571 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8572 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8573 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8574 goto copy_reloc;
8575
8576 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8577 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8578 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8579 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8580 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8581 goto copy_reloc;
8582
8583 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8584 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8585 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8586 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8587 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8588 goto copy_reloc;
8589
8590 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8591 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8592 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8593 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8594 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8595 goto copy_reloc;
8596
8597 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8598 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8599 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8600 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8601 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8602 goto copy_reloc;
8603
8604 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8605 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8606 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8607 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8608 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8609 {
8610 const char *name;
8611 int reg;
8612 unsigned int insn;
8613 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8614
8615 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8616 {
8617 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8618 break;
8619 }
8620
8621 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8622 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8623 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8624 {
8625 reg = 13;
8626 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8627 }
8628 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8629 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8630 {
8631 reg = 2;
8632 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8633 }
8634 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8635 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8636 {
8637 reg = 0;
8638 }
8639 else
8640 {
8641 _bfd_error_handler
8642 /* xgettext:c-format */
8643 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8644 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8645 input_bfd,
8646 sym_name,
8647 howto->name,
8648 name);
8649
8650 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8651 ret = FALSE;
8652 goto copy_reloc;
8653 }
8654
8655 if (sda != NULL)
8656 {
8657 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8658 {
8659 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8660 break;
8661 }
8662 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8663 }
8664
8665 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8666 break;
8667
8668 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8669 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8670 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8671 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8672 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8673 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8674 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8675 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8676 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8677
8678 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8679 if (reg == 0
8680 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8681 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8682 {
8683 relocation = relocation + addend;
8684 addend = 0;
8685
8686 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8687 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8688 insn |= 28u << 26;
8689
8690 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8691 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8692 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8693 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8694 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8695 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8696 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8697
8698 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8699
8700 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8701 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8702 goto overflow;
8703 goto copy_reloc;
8704 }
8705 /* Fill in register field. */
8706 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8707 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8708 }
8709 break;
8710
8711 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8712 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8713 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8714 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8715 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8716 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8717 {
8718 bfd_vma value;
8719 const char *name;
8720 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8721
8722 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8723 {
8724 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8725 break;
8726 }
8727
8728 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8729 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8730 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8731 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8732 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8733 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8734 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8735 else
8736 {
8737 _bfd_error_handler
8738 /* xgettext:c-format */
8739 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8740 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8741 input_bfd,
8742 sym_name,
8743 howto->name,
8744 name);
8745
8746 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8747 ret = FALSE;
8748 goto copy_reloc;
8749 }
8750
8751 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8752 {
8753 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8754 break;
8755 }
8756 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8757
8758 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8759 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8760 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8761 split16a_type,
8762 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8763 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8764 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8765 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8766 split16d_type,
8767 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8768 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8769 {
8770 value = value >> 16;
8771 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8772 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8773 split16a_type,
8774 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8775 }
8776 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8777 {
8778 value = value >> 16;
8779 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8780 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8781 split16d_type,
8782 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8783 }
8784 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8785 {
8786 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8787 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8788 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8789 split16a_type,
8790 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8791 }
8792 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8793 {
8794 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8795 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8796 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8797 split16d_type,
8798 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8799 }
8800 }
8801 goto copy_reloc;
8802
8803 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8804 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8805 continue;
8806
8807 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8808 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8809 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8810 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8811 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8812 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8813 {
8814 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8815 break;
8816 }
8817 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8818 break;
8819
8820 /* Negative relocations. */
8821 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8822 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8823 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8824 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8825 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8826 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8827 break;
8828
8829 case R_PPC_COPY:
8830 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8831 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8832 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8833 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8834 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8835 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8836 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8837 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8838 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8839 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8840 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8841 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8842 /* xgettext:c-format */
8843 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8844 input_bfd, howto->name);
8845
8846 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8847 ret = FALSE;
8848 goto copy_reloc;
8849 }
8850
8851 switch (r_type)
8852 {
8853 default:
8854 break;
8855
8856 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8857 if (unresolved_reloc)
8858 {
8859 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8860 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8861 insn &= 1;
8862 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8863 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8864 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8865 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8866 }
8867 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8868 info->callbacks->einfo
8869 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8870 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8871 howto->name);
8872 break;
8873
8874 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8875 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8876 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8877 if (unresolved_reloc)
8878 {
8879 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8880 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8881 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8882 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8883 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8884 }
8885 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8886 info->callbacks->einfo
8887 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8888 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8889 howto->name);
8890 break;
8891 }
8892
8893 /* Do any further special processing. */
8894 switch (r_type)
8895 {
8896 default:
8897 break;
8898
8899 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8900 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8901 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8902 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8903 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8904 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8905 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8906 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8907 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8908 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8909 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8910 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8911 if (sec == NULL)
8912 break;
8913 /* Fall through. */
8914
8915 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8916 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8917 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8918 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8919 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8920 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8921 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8922 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8923 addend += 0x8000;
8924 break;
8925
8926 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8927 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8928 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8929 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8930 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8931 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8932 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8933 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8934 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8935 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8936 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8937 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8938 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8939 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8940 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8941 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8942 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8943 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8944 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8945 {
8946 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8947 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8948 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8949 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8950
8951 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8952 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8953 mask = 0;
8954 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8955 mask = 3;
8956 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8957 mask = 15;
8958 else
8959 break;
8960 relocation += addend;
8961 addend = insn & mask;
8962 lobit = mask & relocation;
8963 if (lobit != 0)
8964 {
8965 relocation ^= lobit;
8966 info->callbacks->einfo
8967 /* xgettext:c-format */
8968 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8969 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8970 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8971 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8972 ret = FALSE;
8973 }
8974 }
8975 break;
8976 }
8977
8978 #ifdef DEBUG
8979 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8980 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8981 howto->name,
8982 (int) r_type,
8983 sym_name,
8984 r_symndx,
8985 (long) rel->r_offset,
8986 (long) addend);
8987 #endif
8988
8989 if (unresolved_reloc
8990 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8991 && h->def_dynamic)
8992 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8993 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8994 {
8995 info->callbacks->einfo
8996 /* xgettext:c-format */
8997 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8998 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8999 howto->name,
9000 sym_name);
9001 ret = FALSE;
9002 }
9003
9004 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9005 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9006 have different reloc types. */
9007 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9008 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9009 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
9010 {
9011 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9012
9013 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9014 {
9015 unsigned int insn;
9016
9017 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9018 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9019 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9020 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9021 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9022 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9023 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9024 }
9025 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9026 {
9027 alt_howto = *howto;
9028 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9029 howto = &alt_howto;
9030 }
9031 }
9032
9033 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9034 {
9035 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9036 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9037 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9038 else
9039 {
9040 unsigned int insn;
9041
9042 relocation += addend;
9043 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9044 + input_section->output_offset
9045 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9046 relocation >>= 16;
9047 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9048 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9049 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9050 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9051 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9052 }
9053 }
9054 else
9055 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9056 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9057
9058 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9059 {
9060 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9061 {
9062 overflow:
9063 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9064 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9065 if (!warned
9066 && !(h != NULL
9067 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9068 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9069 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9070 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9071 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9072 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9073 }
9074 else
9075 {
9076 info->callbacks->einfo
9077 /* xgettext:c-format */
9078 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9079 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9080 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9081 ret = FALSE;
9082 }
9083 }
9084 copy_reloc:
9085 if (wrel != rel)
9086 *wrel = *rel;
9087 }
9088
9089 if (wrel != rel)
9090 {
9091 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9092 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9093
9094 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9095 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9096 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9097 {
9098 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9099 one NONE reloc.
9100 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9101 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9102 deleted -= 1;
9103 wrel++;
9104 }
9105 relend = wrel;
9106 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9107 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9108 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9109 }
9110
9111 #ifdef DEBUG
9112 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9113 #endif
9114
9115 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9116 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9117 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9118 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9119 {
9120 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9121 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9122 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9123 }
9124
9125 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9126 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9127 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9128 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9129 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9130 {
9131 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9132 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9133
9134 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9135 {
9136 bfd_byte *p;
9137 unsigned int n;
9138 bfd_byte fill[4];
9139
9140 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9141 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9142 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9143 while (n--)
9144 {
9145 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9146 p += 4;
9147 }
9148 }
9149
9150 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9151 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9152 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9153 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9154 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9155
9156 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9157 + input_section->output_offset);
9158 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9159 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9160 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9161 addr < end_addr;
9162 addr += pagesize)
9163 {
9164 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9165 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9166 bfd_boolean is_data;
9167 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9168 unsigned int insn;
9169
9170 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9171 the word alone. */
9172 is_data = FALSE;
9173 lo = relocs;
9174 hi = relend;
9175 rel = NULL;
9176 while (lo < hi)
9177 {
9178 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9179 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9180 lo = rel + 1;
9181 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9182 hi = rel;
9183 else
9184 {
9185 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9186 {
9187 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9188 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9189 case R_PPC_REL32:
9190 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9191 is_data = TRUE;
9192 break;
9193 default:
9194 break;
9195 }
9196 break;
9197 }
9198 }
9199 if (is_data)
9200 continue;
9201
9202 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9203 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9204 avoid the icache failure.
9205
9206 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9207 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9208 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9209 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9210 unconditional branches:
9211 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9212 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9213 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9214 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9215 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9216 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9217 instruction is not executed.
9218
9219 A bctr example:
9220 .
9221 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9222 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9223 . mtctr 9
9224 . bctr
9225 . nop
9226 . nop
9227 . new_page:
9228 .
9229 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9230 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9231 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9232 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9233 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9234 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9235 place:
9236 .
9237 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9238 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9239 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9240 . bctr bctr
9241 . nop b somewhere_else
9242 . b somewhere_else nop
9243 . new_page: new_page:
9244 . */
9245 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9246 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9247 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9248 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9249 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9250 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9251 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9252 continue;
9253
9254 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9255 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9256 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9257 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9258 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9259
9260 if (rel != NULL
9261 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9262 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9263 {
9264 asection *sreloc;
9265
9266 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9267 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9268 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9269 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9270 {
9271 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9272
9273 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9274 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9275 relend[-1] = tmp;
9276 }
9277 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9278
9279 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9280 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9281 {
9282 case R_PPC_REL16:
9283 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9284 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9285 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9286 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9287 break;
9288 default:
9289 break;
9290 }
9291
9292 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9293 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9294 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9295 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9296 if (sreloc != NULL)
9297 {
9298 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9299 bfd_vma soffset;
9300
9301 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9302 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9303 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9304 + input_section->output_offset);
9305 while (slo < shi)
9306 {
9307 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9308 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9309 &outrel);
9310 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9311 slo = srel + 1;
9312 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9313 shi = srel;
9314 else
9315 {
9316 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9317 {
9318 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9319 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9320 srel = srelend - 1;
9321 }
9322 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9323 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9324 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9325 break;
9326 }
9327 }
9328 }
9329 }
9330 else
9331 rel = NULL;
9332
9333 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9334 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9335 {
9336 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9337
9338 delta += offset - patch_off;
9339 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9340 delta = 0;
9341 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9342 {
9343 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9344
9345 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9346 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9347 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9348 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9349 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9350 else
9351 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9352
9353 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9354 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9355 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9356 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9357 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9358 }
9359 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9360 {
9361 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9362 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9363 contents + patch_off);
9364 patch_off += 4;
9365 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9366 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9367 contents + patch_off);
9368 patch_off += 4;
9369 }
9370 else
9371 {
9372 if (rel != NULL)
9373 {
9374 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9375
9376 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9377 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9378 }
9379 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9380 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9381 contents + patch_off);
9382 patch_off += 4;
9383 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9384 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9385 contents + patch_off);
9386 patch_off += 4;
9387 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9388 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9389 contents + patch_off);
9390 patch_off += 4;
9391 }
9392 }
9393 else
9394 {
9395 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9396 patch_off += 4;
9397 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9398 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9399 contents + patch_off);
9400 patch_off += 4;
9401 }
9402 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9403 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9404 }
9405 }
9406
9407 return ret;
9408 }
9409 \f
9410 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9411
9412 static bfd_boolean
9413 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9414 {
9415 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9416 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9417 struct plt_entry *ent;
9418 bfd_boolean doneone;
9419
9420 doneone = FALSE;
9421 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9422 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9423 {
9424 if (!doneone)
9425 {
9426 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9427 bfd_byte *loc;
9428 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9429 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9430 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9431
9432 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9433 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9434 || h->dynindx == -1)
9435 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9436 else
9437 {
9438 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9439 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9440 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9441 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9442 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9443 }
9444
9445 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9446 Set it up. */
9447 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9448 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9449 && h->dynindx != -1)
9450 {
9451 bfd_vma got_offset;
9452 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9453
9454 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9455 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9456
9457 /* Use the right PLT. */
9458 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9459 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9460
9461 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9462 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9463 {
9464 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9465 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9466 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9467 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9468 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9469 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9470 }
9471 else
9472 {
9473 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9474
9475 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9476 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9477 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9478 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9479 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9480 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9481 }
9482
9483 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9484 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9485 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9486 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9487
9488 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9489 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9490 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9491 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9492 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9493 prescaled offset. */
9494 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9495 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9496 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9497 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9498 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9499 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9500 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9501 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9502 offset. */
9503 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9504 (plt_entry[5]
9505 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9506 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9507 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9508 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9509 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9510 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9511
9512 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9513 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9514 in this PLT entry. */
9515 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9516 + plt->output_offset
9517 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9518 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9519
9520 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9521 {
9522 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9523 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9524 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9525 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9526 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9527
9528 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9529 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9530 + plt->output_offset
9531 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9532 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9533 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9534 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9535 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9536 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9537
9538 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9539 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9540 + plt->output_offset
9541 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9542 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9543 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9544 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9545 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9546 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9547
9548 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9549 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9550 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9551 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9552 + got_offset);
9553 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9554 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9555 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9556 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9557 }
9558
9559 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9560 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9561 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9562 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9563 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9564 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9565 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9566 + got_offset);
9567 rela.r_addend = 0;
9568 }
9569 else
9570 {
9571 rela.r_addend = 0;
9572 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9573 || h->dynindx == -1)
9574 {
9575 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9576 {
9577 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9578 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9579 }
9580 else
9581 {
9582 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9583 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9584 }
9585 if (h->def_regular
9586 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9587 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9588 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9589 }
9590
9591 if (relplt == NULL)
9592 {
9593 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9594 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9595 }
9596 else
9597 {
9598 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9599 + plt->output_offset
9600 + ent->plt.offset);
9601
9602 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9603 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9604 || h->dynindx == -1)
9605 {
9606 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9607 linker will fill it in. */
9608 }
9609 else
9610 {
9611 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9612 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9613 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9614 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9615 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9616 }
9617 }
9618 }
9619
9620 if (relplt != NULL)
9621 {
9622 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9623 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9624 || h->dynindx == -1)
9625 {
9626 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9627 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9628 else
9629 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9630 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9631 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9632 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9633 }
9634 else
9635 {
9636 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9637 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9638 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9639 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9640 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9641 }
9642 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9643 }
9644 doneone = TRUE;
9645 }
9646
9647 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9648 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9649 || h->dynindx == -1)
9650 {
9651 unsigned char *p;
9652 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9653
9654 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9655 || h->dynindx == -1)
9656 {
9657 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9658 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9659 else
9660 break;
9661 }
9662
9663 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9664 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9665
9666 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9667 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9668 break;
9669 }
9670 else
9671 break;
9672 }
9673 return TRUE;
9674 }
9675
9676 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9677
9678 bfd_boolean
9679 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9680 {
9681 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9682 bfd *ibfd;
9683
9684 if (!htab)
9685 return TRUE;
9686
9687 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9688
9689 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9690 {
9691 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9692 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9693 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9694 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9695 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9696 struct plt_entry *ent;
9697
9698 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9699 continue;
9700
9701 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9702 if (!local_got)
9703 continue;
9704
9705 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9706 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9707 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9708 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9709 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9710 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9711 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9712 {
9713 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9714 {
9715 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9716 asection *sym_sec;
9717 asection *plt, *relplt;
9718 bfd_byte *loc;
9719 bfd_vma val;
9720 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9721 unsigned char *p;
9722
9723 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9724 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9725 {
9726 if (local_syms != NULL
9727 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9728 free (local_syms);
9729 return FALSE;
9730 }
9731
9732 val = sym->st_value;
9733 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9734 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9735
9736 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9737 {
9738 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9739 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9740 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9741 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9742 }
9743 else
9744 {
9745 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9746 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9747 {
9748 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9749 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9750 }
9751 else
9752 {
9753 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9754 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9755 continue;
9756 }
9757 }
9758
9759 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9760 + plt->output_offset
9761 + plt->output_section->vma);
9762 rela.r_addend = val;
9763 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9764 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9765 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9766
9767 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9768 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9769 }
9770 }
9771
9772 if (local_syms != NULL
9773 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9774 {
9775 if (!info->keep_memory)
9776 free (local_syms);
9777 else
9778 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9779 }
9780 }
9781 return TRUE;
9782 }
9783
9784 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9785 dynamic sections here. */
9786
9787 static bfd_boolean
9788 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9789 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9790 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9791 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9792 {
9793 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9794 struct plt_entry *ent;
9795
9796 #ifdef DEBUG
9797 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9798 h->root.root.string);
9799 #endif
9800
9801 if (!h->def_regular
9802 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9803 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9804 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9805 {
9806 if (!h->def_regular)
9807 {
9808 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9809 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9810 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9811 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9812 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9813 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9814 to zero. */
9815 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9816 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9817 sym->st_value = 0;
9818 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9819 {
9820 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9821 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9822 function pointer. */
9823 sym->st_value = 0;
9824 }
9825 }
9826 else
9827 {
9828 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9829 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9830 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9831 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9832 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9833 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9834 relocation. */
9835 sym->st_shndx
9836 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9837 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9838 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9839 + htab->glink->output_offset
9840 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9841 }
9842 break;
9843 }
9844
9845 if (h->needs_copy)
9846 {
9847 asection *s;
9848 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9849 bfd_byte *loc;
9850
9851 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9852
9853 #ifdef DEBUG
9854 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9855 #endif
9856
9857 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9858
9859 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9860 s = htab->relsbss;
9861 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9862 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9863 else
9864 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9865 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9866
9867 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9868 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9869 rela.r_addend = 0;
9870 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9871 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9872 }
9873
9874 #ifdef DEBUG
9875 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9876 #endif
9877
9878 return TRUE;
9879 }
9880 \f
9881 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9882 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9883 const asection *rel_sec,
9884 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9885 {
9886 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9887
9888 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9889 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9890
9891 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9892 {
9893 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9894 return reloc_class_relative;
9895 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9896 return reloc_class_plt;
9897 case R_PPC_COPY:
9898 return reloc_class_copy;
9899 default:
9900 return reloc_class_normal;
9901 }
9902 }
9903 \f
9904 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9905
9906 static bfd_boolean
9907 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9908 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9909 {
9910 asection *sdyn;
9911 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9912 bfd_vma got;
9913 bfd *dynobj;
9914 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9915
9916 #ifdef DEBUG
9917 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9918 #endif
9919
9920 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9921 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9922 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9923
9924 got = 0;
9925 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9926 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9927
9928 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9929 {
9930 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9931
9932 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9933
9934 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9935 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9936 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9937 {
9938 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9939 asection *s;
9940
9941 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9942
9943 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9944 {
9945 case DT_PLTGOT:
9946 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9947 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9948 else
9949 s = htab->elf.splt;
9950 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9951 break;
9952
9953 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9954 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9955 break;
9956
9957 case DT_JMPREL:
9958 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9959 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9960 break;
9961
9962 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9963 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9964 break;
9965
9966 case DT_TEXTREL:
9967 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9968 info->callbacks->einfo
9969 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9970 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9971 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9972 info->callbacks->einfo
9973 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9974 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9975 continue;
9976
9977 default:
9978 if (htab->is_vxworks
9979 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9980 break;
9981 continue;
9982 }
9983
9984 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9985 }
9986 }
9987
9988 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9989 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9990 {
9991 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9992 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9993 {
9994 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9995
9996 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9997 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9998 {
9999 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10000 so that a function can easily find the address of
10001 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10002 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10003 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10004 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10005 }
10006
10007 if (sdyn != NULL)
10008 {
10009 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10010 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10011 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10012 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10013 }
10014 }
10015 else
10016 {
10017 /* xgettext:c-format */
10018 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10019 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10020 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10021 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10022 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10023 ret = FALSE;
10024 }
10025
10026 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10027 }
10028
10029 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10030 if (htab->is_vxworks
10031 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10032 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10033 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10034 {
10035 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10036 /* Use the right PLT. */
10037 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10038 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10039 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10040
10041 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10042 {
10043 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10044
10045 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10046 splt->contents + 0);
10047 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10048 splt->contents + 4);
10049 }
10050 else
10051 {
10052 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10053 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10054 }
10055 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10056 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10057 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10058 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10059 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10060 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10061
10062 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10063 {
10064 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10065 bfd_byte *loc;
10066
10067 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10068
10069 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10070 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10071 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10072 + 2);
10073 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10074 rela.r_addend = 0;
10075 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10076 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10077
10078 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10079 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10080 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10081 + 6);
10082 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10083 rela.r_addend = 0;
10084 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10085 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10086
10087 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10088 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10089 in which symbols were output. */
10090 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10091 {
10092 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10093
10094 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10095 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10096 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10097 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10098
10099 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10100 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10101 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10102 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10103
10104 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10105 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10106 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10107 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10108 }
10109 }
10110 }
10111
10112 if (htab->glink != NULL
10113 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10114 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10115 {
10116 unsigned char *p;
10117 unsigned char *endp;
10118 bfd_vma res0;
10119
10120 /*
10121 * PIC glink code is the following:
10122 *
10123 * # ith PLT code stub.
10124 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10125 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10126 * mtctr 11
10127 * bctr
10128 *
10129 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10130 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10131 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10132 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10133 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10134 * .
10135 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10136 * res_n_m3: nop
10137 * res_n_m2: nop
10138 * res_n_m1:
10139 *
10140 * PLTresolve:
10141 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10142 * mflr 0
10143 * bcl 20,31,1f
10144 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10145 * mflr 12
10146 * mtlr 0
10147 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10148 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10149 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10150 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10151 * mtctr 0
10152 * add 0,11,11
10153 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10154 * bctr
10155 *
10156 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10157 *
10158 * # ith PLT code stub.
10159 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10160 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10161 * mtctr 11
10162 * bctr
10163 *
10164 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10165 *
10166 * PLTresolve:
10167 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10168 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10169 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10170 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10171 * mtctr 0
10172 * add 0,11,11
10173 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10174 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10175 * bctr
10176 */
10177
10178 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10179 and perhaps some padding. */
10180 p = htab->glink->contents;
10181 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10182 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10183 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10184 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10185 {
10186 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10187 p += 4;
10188 }
10189 while (p < endp)
10190 {
10191 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10192 p += 4;
10193 }
10194
10195 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10196 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10197 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10198
10199 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10200 {
10201 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10202 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10203 glink branch table. */
10204 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10205 bfd_vma page_addr;
10206 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10207 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10208
10209 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10210 page_addr > glink_start;
10211 page_addr -= pagesize)
10212 {
10213 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10214 bfd_byte *loc;
10215 unsigned int insn;
10216
10217 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10218 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10219 if (insn == BCTR)
10220 {
10221 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10222 one other call stub before this one. */
10223 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10224 if (insn == BCTR)
10225 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10226 else
10227 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10228 }
10229 }
10230 }
10231
10232 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10233 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10234 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10235 {
10236 bfd_vma bcl;
10237
10238 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10239 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10240 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10241
10242 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10243 p += 4;
10244 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10245 p += 4;
10246 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10247 p += 4;
10248 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10249 p += 4;
10250 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10251 p += 4;
10252 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10253 p += 4;
10254 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10255 p += 4;
10256 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10257 p += 4;
10258 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10259 {
10260 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10261 p += 4;
10262 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10263 p += 4;
10264 }
10265 else
10266 {
10267 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10268 p += 4;
10269 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10270 p += 4;
10271 }
10272 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10273 p += 4;
10274 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10275 }
10276 else
10277 {
10278 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10279 p += 4;
10280 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10281 p += 4;
10282 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10283 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10284 else
10285 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10286 p += 4;
10287 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10288 p += 4;
10289 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10290 p += 4;
10291 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10292 p += 4;
10293 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10294 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10295 else
10296 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10297 }
10298 p += 4;
10299 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10300 p += 4;
10301 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10302 p += 4;
10303 while (p < endp)
10304 {
10305 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10306 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10307 p += 4;
10308 }
10309 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10310 }
10311
10312 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10313 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10314 {
10315 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10316 bfd_vma val;
10317
10318 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10319 /* FDE length. */
10320 p += 4;
10321 /* CIE pointer. */
10322 p += 4;
10323 /* Offset to .glink. */
10324 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10325 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10326 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10327 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10328 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10329 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10330
10331 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10332 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10333 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10334 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10335 return FALSE;
10336 }
10337
10338 return ret;
10339 }
10340 \f
10341 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10342 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10343 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10344 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10345 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10346 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10347 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10348 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10349 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10350 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10351 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10352
10353 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10354 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10355 #endif
10356
10357 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10358 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10359 #endif
10360
10361 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10362 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10363 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10364 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10365 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10366 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10367
10368 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10369 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10370 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10371 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10372 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10373 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10374 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10375 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10376
10377 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10378 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10379 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10380 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10381 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10382 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10383 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10384 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10385 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10386 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10387 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10388 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10389 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10390 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10391 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10392 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10393 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10394 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10395 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10396 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10397 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10398 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10399 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10400 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10401 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10402 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10403 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10404 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10405 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10406
10407 #include "elf32-target.h"
10408
10409 /* FreeBSD Target */
10410
10411 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10412 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10413
10414 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10415 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10416 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10417 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10418
10419 #undef ELF_OSABI
10420 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10421
10422 #undef elf32_bed
10423 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10424
10425 #include "elf32-target.h"
10426
10427 /* VxWorks Target */
10428
10429 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10430 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10431
10432 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10433 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10434 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10435 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10436
10437 #undef ELF_OSABI
10438
10439 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10440 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10441 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10442 {
10443 if (sec->name == NULL)
10444 return NULL;
10445
10446 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10447 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10448
10449 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10450 }
10451
10452 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10453 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10454 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10455 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10456 {
10457 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10458
10459 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10460 if (ret)
10461 {
10462 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10463 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10464 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10465 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10466 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10467 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10468 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10469 }
10470 return ret;
10471 }
10472
10473 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10474 static bfd_boolean
10475 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10476 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10477 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10478 const char **namep,
10479 flagword *flagsp,
10480 asection **secp,
10481 bfd_vma *valp)
10482 {
10483 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10484 valp))
10485 return FALSE;
10486
10487 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10488 }
10489
10490 static bfd_boolean
10491 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10492 {
10493 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10494 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10495 }
10496
10497 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10498 define it. */
10499 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10500 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10501 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10502 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10503 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10504 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10505 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10506 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10507 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10508 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10509 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10510 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10511 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10512 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10513
10514 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10515
10516 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10517 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10518 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10519 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10520 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10521 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10522 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10523 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10524 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10525 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10526 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10527 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10528 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10529 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10530 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10531 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10532 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10533 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10534
10535 #undef elf32_bed
10536 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10537 #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
10538
10539 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.440986 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.